xref: /linux/include/net/mac80211.h (revision dfecb0c5af3b07ebfa84be63a7a21bfc9e29a872)
1 /* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */
2 /*
3  * mac80211 <-> driver interface
4  *
5  * Copyright 2002-2005, Devicescape Software, Inc.
6  * Copyright 2006-2007	Jiri Benc <jbenc@suse.cz>
7  * Copyright 2007-2010	Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net>
8  * Copyright 2013-2014  Intel Mobile Communications GmbH
9  * Copyright (C) 2015 - 2017 Intel Deutschland GmbH
10  * Copyright (C) 2018 - 2026 Intel Corporation
11  */
12 
13 #ifndef MAC80211_H
14 #define MAC80211_H
15 
16 #include <linux/bug.h>
17 #include <linux/kernel.h>
18 #include <linux/if_ether.h>
19 #include <linux/skbuff.h>
20 #include <linux/ieee80211.h>
21 #include <linux/lockdep.h>
22 #include <net/cfg80211.h>
23 #include <net/codel.h>
24 #include <net/ieee80211_radiotap.h>
25 #include <linux/unaligned.h>
26 
27 /**
28  * DOC: Introduction
29  *
30  * mac80211 is the Linux stack for 802.11 hardware that implements
31  * only partial functionality in hard- or firmware. This document
32  * defines the interface between mac80211 and low-level hardware
33  * drivers.
34  */
35 
36 /**
37  * DOC: Calling mac80211 from interrupts
38  *
39  * Only ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() can be
40  * called in hardware interrupt context. The low-level driver must not call any
41  * other functions in hardware interrupt context. If there is a need for such
42  * call, the low-level driver should first ACK the interrupt and perform the
43  * IEEE 802.11 code call after this, e.g. from a scheduled workqueue or even
44  * tasklet function.
45  *
46  * NOTE: If the driver opts to use the _irqsafe() functions, it may not also
47  *	 use the non-IRQ-safe functions!
48  */
49 
50 /**
51  * DOC: Warning
52  *
53  * If you're reading this document and not the header file itself, it will
54  * be incomplete because not all documentation has been converted yet.
55  */
56 
57 /**
58  * DOC: Frame format
59  *
60  * As a general rule, when frames are passed between mac80211 and the driver,
61  * they start with the IEEE 802.11 header and include the same octets that are
62  * sent over the air except for the FCS which should be calculated by the
63  * hardware.
64  *
65  * There are, however, various exceptions to this rule for advanced features:
66  *
67  * The first exception is for hardware encryption and decryption offload
68  * where the IV/ICV may or may not be generated in hardware.
69  *
70  * Secondly, when the hardware handles fragmentation, the frame handed to
71  * the driver from mac80211 is the MSDU, not the MPDU.
72  */
73 
74 /**
75  * DOC: mac80211 workqueue
76  *
77  * mac80211 provides its own workqueue for drivers and internal mac80211 use.
78  * The workqueue is a single threaded workqueue and can only be accessed by
79  * helpers for sanity checking. Drivers must ensure all work added onto the
80  * mac80211 workqueue should be cancelled on the driver stop() callback.
81  *
82  * mac80211 will flush the workqueue upon interface removal and during
83  * suspend.
84  *
85  * All work performed on the mac80211 workqueue must not acquire the RTNL lock.
86  *
87  */
88 
89 /**
90  * DOC: mac80211 software tx queueing
91  *
92  * mac80211 uses an intermediate queueing implementation, designed to allow the
93  * driver to keep hardware queues short and to provide some fairness between
94  * different stations/interfaces.
95  *
96  * Drivers must provide the .wake_tx_queue driver operation by either
97  * linking it to ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() or implementing a custom
98  * handler.
99  *
100  * Intermediate queues (struct ieee80211_txq) are kept per-sta per-tid, with
101  * another per-sta for non-data/non-mgmt and bufferable management frames, and
102  * a single per-vif queue for multicast data frames.
103  *
104  * The driver is expected to initialize its private per-queue data for stations
105  * and interfaces in the .add_interface and .sta_add ops.
106  *
107  * The driver can't access the internal TX queues (iTXQs) directly.
108  * Whenever mac80211 adds a new frame to a queue, it calls the .wake_tx_queue
109  * driver op.
110  * Drivers implementing a custom .wake_tx_queue op can get them by calling
111  * ieee80211_tx_dequeue(). Drivers using ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() will
112  * simply get the individual frames pushed via the .tx driver operation.
113  *
114  * Drivers can optionally delegate responsibility for scheduling queues to
115  * mac80211, to take advantage of airtime fairness accounting. In this case, to
116  * obtain the next queue to pull frames from, the driver calls
117  * ieee80211_next_txq(). The driver is then expected to return the txq using
118  * ieee80211_return_txq().
119  *
120  * For AP powersave TIM handling, the driver only needs to indicate if it has
121  * buffered packets in the driver specific data structures by calling
122  * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(). For frames buffered in the ieee80211_txq
123  * struct, mac80211 sets the appropriate TIM PVB bits and calls
124  * .release_buffered_frames().
125  * In that callback the driver is therefore expected to release its own
126  * buffered frames and afterwards also frames from the ieee80211_txq (obtained
127  * via the usual ieee80211_tx_dequeue).
128  */
129 
130 /**
131  * DOC: HW timestamping
132  *
133  * Timing Measurement and Fine Timing Measurement require accurate timestamps
134  * of the action frames TX/RX and their respective acks.
135  *
136  * To report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine Timing
137  * Measurement frame RX, the low level driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp
138  * field to the frame RX timestamp and report the ack TX timestamp in the
139  * ieee80211_rx_status struct.
140  *
141  * Similarly, to report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine
142  * Timing Measurement frame TX, the driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp field
143  * to the frame TX timestamp and report the ack RX timestamp in the
144  * ieee80211_tx_status struct.
145  */
146 struct device;
147 
148 /**
149  * enum ieee80211_max_queues - maximum number of queues
150  *
151  * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES: Maximum number of regular device queues.
152  * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP: bitmap with maximum queues set
153  */
154 enum ieee80211_max_queues {
155 	IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES =		16,
156 	IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP =	BIT(IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES) - 1,
157 };
158 
159 #define IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE	0xff
160 
161 /**
162  * enum ieee80211_ac_numbers - AC numbers as used in mac80211
163  * @IEEE80211_AC_VO: voice
164  * @IEEE80211_AC_VI: video
165  * @IEEE80211_AC_BE: best effort
166  * @IEEE80211_AC_BK: background
167  */
168 enum ieee80211_ac_numbers {
169 	IEEE80211_AC_VO		= 0,
170 	IEEE80211_AC_VI		= 1,
171 	IEEE80211_AC_BE		= 2,
172 	IEEE80211_AC_BK		= 3,
173 };
174 
175 /**
176  * struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params - transmit queue configuration
177  *
178  * The information provided in this structure is required for QoS
179  * transmit queue configuration. Cf. IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.29.
180  *
181  * @aifs: arbitration interframe space [0..255]
182  * @cw_min: minimum contention window [a value of the form
183  *	2^n-1 in the range 1..32767]
184  * @cw_max: maximum contention window [like @cw_min]
185  * @txop: maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled
186  * @acm: is mandatory admission control required for the access category
187  * @uapsd: is U-APSD mode enabled for the queue
188  * @mu_edca: is the MU EDCA configured
189  * @mu_edca_param_rec: MU EDCA Parameter Record for HE
190  */
191 struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params {
192 	u16 txop;
193 	u16 cw_min;
194 	u16 cw_max;
195 	u8 aifs;
196 	bool acm;
197 	bool uapsd;
198 	bool mu_edca;
199 	struct ieee80211_he_mu_edca_param_ac_rec mu_edca_param_rec;
200 };
201 
202 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats {
203 	unsigned int dot11ACKFailureCount;
204 	unsigned int dot11RTSFailureCount;
205 	unsigned int dot11FCSErrorCount;
206 	unsigned int dot11RTSSuccessCount;
207 };
208 
209 /**
210  * enum ieee80211_chanctx_change - change flag for channel context
211  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH: The channel width changed
212  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS: The number of RX chains changed
213  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR: radar detection flag changed
214  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL: switched to another operating channel,
215  *	this is used only with channel switching with CSA
216  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_DEF: The min chandef changed
217  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_AP: The AP channel definition changed, so (wider
218  *	bandwidth) OFDMA settings need to be changed
219  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_PUNCTURING: The punctured channel(s) bitmap
220  *	was changed.
221  */
222 enum ieee80211_chanctx_change {
223 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH		= BIT(0),
224 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS	= BIT(1),
225 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR		= BIT(2),
226 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL	= BIT(3),
227 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_DEF	= BIT(4),
228 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_AP		= BIT(5),
229 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_PUNCTURING	= BIT(6),
230 };
231 
232 /**
233  * struct ieee80211_chan_req - A channel "request"
234  * @oper: channel definition to use for operation
235  * @ap: the channel definition of the AP, if any
236  *	(otherwise the chan member is %NULL)
237  */
238 struct ieee80211_chan_req {
239 	struct cfg80211_chan_def oper;
240 	struct cfg80211_chan_def ap;
241 };
242 
243 /**
244  * struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf - channel context that vifs may be tuned to
245  *
246  * This is the driver-visible part. The ieee80211_chanctx
247  * that contains it is visible in mac80211 only.
248  *
249  * @def: the channel definition
250  * @min_def: the minimum channel definition currently required.
251  * @ap: the channel definition the AP actually is operating as,
252  *	for use with (wider bandwidth) OFDMA
253  * @radio_idx: index of the wiphy radio used used for this channel
254  * @rx_chains_static: The number of RX chains that must always be
255  *	active on the channel to receive MIMO transmissions
256  * @rx_chains_dynamic: The number of RX chains that must be enabled
257  *	after RTS/CTS handshake to receive SMPS MIMO transmissions;
258  *	this will always be >= @rx_chains_static.
259  * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled on this channel.
260  * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
261  *	sizeof(void *), size is determined in hw information.
262  */
263 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf {
264 	struct cfg80211_chan_def def;
265 	struct cfg80211_chan_def min_def;
266 	struct cfg80211_chan_def ap;
267 
268 	int radio_idx;
269 	u8 rx_chains_static, rx_chains_dynamic;
270 
271 	bool radar_enabled;
272 
273 	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
274 };
275 
276 /**
277  * enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode - channel context switch mode
278  * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF: Both old and new contexts already
279  *	exist (and will continue to exist), but the virtual interface
280  *	needs to be switched from one to the other.
281  * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS: The old context exists but will stop
282  *      to exist with this call, the new context doesn't exist but
283  *      will be active after this call, the virtual interface switches
284  *      from the old to the new (note that the driver may of course
285  *      implement this as an on-the-fly chandef switch of the existing
286  *      hardware context, but the mac80211 pointer for the old context
287  *      will cease to exist and only the new one will later be used
288  *      for changes/removal.)
289  */
290 enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode {
291 	CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF,
292 	CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS,
293 };
294 
295 /**
296  * struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch - vif chanctx switch information
297  *
298  * This is structure is used to pass information about a vif that
299  * needs to switch from one chanctx to another.  The
300  * &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode defines how the switch should be
301  * done.
302  *
303  * @vif: the vif that should be switched from old_ctx to new_ctx
304  * @link_conf: the link conf that's switching
305  * @old_ctx: the old context to which the vif was assigned
306  * @new_ctx: the new context to which the vif must be assigned
307  */
308 struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch {
309 	struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
310 	struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf;
311 	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *old_ctx;
312 	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *new_ctx;
313 };
314 
315 /**
316  * enum ieee80211_bss_change - BSS change notification flags
317  *
318  * These flags are used with the bss_info_changed(), link_info_changed()
319  * and vif_cfg_changed() callbacks to indicate which parameter(s) changed.
320  *
321  * @BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC: association status changed (associated/disassociated),
322  *	also implies a change in the AID.
323  * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT: CTS protection changed
324  * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE: preamble changed
325  * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT: slot timing changed
326  * @BSS_CHANGED_HT: 802.11n parameters changed
327  * @BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES: Basic rateset changed
328  * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT: Beacon interval changed
329  * @BSS_CHANGED_BSSID: BSSID changed, for whatever
330  *	reason (IBSS and managed mode)
331  * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON: Beacon data changed, retrieve
332  *	new beacon (beaconing modes)
333  * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED: Beaconing should be
334  *	enabled/disabled (beaconing modes)
335  * @BSS_CHANGED_CQM: Connection quality monitor config changed
336  * @BSS_CHANGED_IBSS: IBSS join status changed
337  * @BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER: Hardware ARP filter address list or state changed.
338  * @BSS_CHANGED_QOS: QoS for this association was enabled/disabled. Note
339  *	that it is only ever disabled for station mode.
340  * @BSS_CHANGED_IDLE: Idle changed for this BSS/interface.
341  * @BSS_CHANGED_SSID: SSID changed for this BSS (AP and IBSS mode)
342  * @BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP: Probe Response changed for this BSS (AP mode)
343  * @BSS_CHANGED_PS: PS changed for this BSS (STA mode)
344  * @BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER: TX power setting changed for this interface
345  * @BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS: P2P powersave settings (CTWindow, opportunistic PS)
346  *	changed
347  * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO: Data from the AP's beacon became available:
348  *	currently dtim_period only is under consideration.
349  * @BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH: The bandwidth used by this interface changed,
350  *	note that this is only called when it changes after the channel
351  *	context had been assigned.
352  * @BSS_CHANGED_OCB: OCB join status changed
353  * @BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS: VHT MU-MIMO group id or user position changed
354  * @BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE: keep alive options (idle period or protected
355  *	keep alive) changed.
356  * @BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE: Multicast Rate setting changed for this interface
357  * @BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER: fine timing measurement request responder
358  *	functionality changed for this BSS (AP mode).
359  * @BSS_CHANGED_TWT: TWT status changed
360  * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD: OBSS Packet Detection status changed.
361  * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR: BSS Color has changed
362  * @BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY: FILS discovery status changed.
363  * @BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
364  *	status changed.
365  * @BSS_CHANGED_MLD_VALID_LINKS: MLD valid links status changed.
366  * @BSS_CHANGED_MLD_TTLM: negotiated TID to link mapping was changed
367  * @BSS_CHANGED_TPE: transmit power envelope changed
368  */
369 enum ieee80211_bss_change {
370 	BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC		= 1<<0,
371 	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT	= 1<<1,
372 	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE	= 1<<2,
373 	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT		= 1<<3,
374 	BSS_CHANGED_HT			= 1<<4,
375 	BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES		= 1<<5,
376 	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT		= 1<<6,
377 	BSS_CHANGED_BSSID		= 1<<7,
378 	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON		= 1<<8,
379 	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED	= 1<<9,
380 	BSS_CHANGED_CQM			= 1<<10,
381 	BSS_CHANGED_IBSS		= 1<<11,
382 	BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER		= 1<<12,
383 	BSS_CHANGED_QOS			= 1<<13,
384 	BSS_CHANGED_IDLE		= 1<<14,
385 	BSS_CHANGED_SSID		= 1<<15,
386 	BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP	= 1<<16,
387 	BSS_CHANGED_PS			= 1<<17,
388 	BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER		= 1<<18,
389 	BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS		= 1<<19,
390 	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO		= 1<<20,
391 	BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH		= 1<<21,
392 	BSS_CHANGED_OCB                 = 1<<22,
393 	BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS		= 1<<23,
394 	BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE		= 1<<24,
395 	BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE		= 1<<25,
396 	BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER	= 1<<26,
397 	BSS_CHANGED_TWT			= 1<<27,
398 	BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD		= 1<<28,
399 	BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR	= 1<<29,
400 	BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY      = 1<<30,
401 	BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP = BIT_ULL(31),
402 	BSS_CHANGED_MLD_VALID_LINKS	= BIT_ULL(33),
403 	BSS_CHANGED_MLD_TTLM		= BIT_ULL(34),
404 	BSS_CHANGED_TPE			= BIT_ULL(35),
405 
406 	/* when adding here, make sure to change ieee80211_reconfig */
407 };
408 
409 /*
410  * The maximum number of IPv4 addresses listed for ARP filtering. If the number
411  * of addresses for an interface increase beyond this value, hardware ARP
412  * filtering will be disabled.
413  */
414 #define IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN 4
415 
416 /**
417  * enum ieee80211_event_type - event to be notified to the low level driver
418  * @RSSI_EVENT: AP's rssi crossed the a threshold set by the driver.
419  * @MLME_EVENT: event related to MLME
420  * @BAR_RX_EVENT: a BAR was received
421  * @BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT: Frames were released from the reordering buffer because
422  *	they timed out. This won't be called for each frame released, but only
423  *	once each time the timeout triggers.
424  */
425 enum ieee80211_event_type {
426 	RSSI_EVENT,
427 	MLME_EVENT,
428 	BAR_RX_EVENT,
429 	BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT,
430 };
431 
432 /**
433  * enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data - relevant when event type is %RSSI_EVENT
434  * @RSSI_EVENT_HIGH: AP's rssi went below the threshold set by the driver.
435  * @RSSI_EVENT_LOW: AP's rssi went above the threshold set by the driver.
436  */
437 enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data {
438 	RSSI_EVENT_HIGH,
439 	RSSI_EVENT_LOW,
440 };
441 
442 /**
443  * struct ieee80211_rssi_event - data attached to an %RSSI_EVENT
444  * @data: See &enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data
445  */
446 struct ieee80211_rssi_event {
447 	enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data data;
448 };
449 
450 /**
451  * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
452  * @AUTH_EVENT: the MLME operation is authentication
453  * @ASSOC_EVENT: the MLME operation is association
454  * @DEAUTH_RX_EVENT: deauth received..
455  * @DEAUTH_TX_EVENT: deauth sent.
456  */
457 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data {
458 	AUTH_EVENT,
459 	ASSOC_EVENT,
460 	DEAUTH_RX_EVENT,
461 	DEAUTH_TX_EVENT,
462 };
463 
464 /**
465  * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
466  * @MLME_SUCCESS: the MLME operation completed successfully.
467  * @MLME_DENIED: the MLME operation was denied by the peer.
468  * @MLME_TIMEOUT: the MLME operation timed out.
469  */
470 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status {
471 	MLME_SUCCESS,
472 	MLME_DENIED,
473 	MLME_TIMEOUT,
474 };
475 
476 /**
477  * struct ieee80211_mlme_event - data attached to an %MLME_EVENT
478  * @data: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data
479  * @status: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status
480  * @reason: the reason code if applicable
481  */
482 struct ieee80211_mlme_event {
483 	enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data data;
484 	enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status status;
485 	u16 reason;
486 };
487 
488 /**
489  * struct ieee80211_ba_event - data attached for BlockAck related events
490  * @sta: pointer to the &ieee80211_sta to which this event relates
491  * @tid: the tid
492  * @ssn: the starting sequence number (for %BAR_RX_EVENT)
493  */
494 struct ieee80211_ba_event {
495 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
496 	u16 tid;
497 	u16 ssn;
498 };
499 
500 /**
501  * struct ieee80211_event - event to be sent to the driver
502  * @type: The event itself. See &enum ieee80211_event_type.
503  * @u.rssi: relevant if &type is %RSSI_EVENT
504  * @u.mlme: relevant if &type is %AUTH_EVENT
505  * @u.ba: relevant if &type is %BAR_RX_EVENT or %BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT
506  * @u:union holding the fields above
507  */
508 struct ieee80211_event {
509 	enum ieee80211_event_type type;
510 	union {
511 		struct ieee80211_rssi_event rssi;
512 		struct ieee80211_mlme_event mlme;
513 		struct ieee80211_ba_event ba;
514 	} u;
515 };
516 
517 /**
518  * struct ieee80211_mu_group_data - STA's VHT MU-MIMO group data
519  *
520  * This structure describes the group id data of VHT MU-MIMO
521  *
522  * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
523  * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
524  */
525 struct ieee80211_mu_group_data {
526 	u8 membership[WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN];
527 	u8 position[WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN];
528 };
529 
530 /**
531  * struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params - FTM responder parameters
532  *
533  * @lci: LCI subelement content
534  * @civicloc: CIVIC location subelement content
535  * @lci_len: LCI data length
536  * @civicloc_len: Civic data length
537  */
538 struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params {
539 	const u8 *lci;
540 	const u8 *civicloc;
541 	size_t lci_len;
542 	size_t civicloc_len;
543 };
544 
545 /**
546  * struct ieee80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from
547  * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail.
548  *
549  * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
550  * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
551  */
552 struct ieee80211_fils_discovery {
553 	u32 min_interval;
554 	u32 max_interval;
555 };
556 
557 #define IEEE80211_TPE_EIRP_ENTRIES_320MHZ	5
558 struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe_eirp {
559 	bool valid;
560 	s8 power[IEEE80211_TPE_EIRP_ENTRIES_320MHZ];
561 	u8 count;
562 };
563 
564 #define IEEE80211_TPE_PSD_ENTRIES_320MHZ	16
565 struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe_psd {
566 	bool valid;
567 	s8 power[IEEE80211_TPE_PSD_ENTRIES_320MHZ];
568 	u8 count, n;
569 };
570 
571 /**
572  * struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe - parsed transmit power envelope information
573  * @max_local: maximum local EIRP, one value for 20, 40, 80, 160, 320 MHz each
574  *	(indexed by TX power category)
575  * @max_reg_client: maximum regulatory client EIRP, one value for 20, 40, 80,
576  *	160, 320 MHz each
577  *	(indexed by TX power category)
578  * @psd_local: maximum local power spectral density, one value for each 20 MHz
579  *	subchannel per bss_conf's chanreq.oper
580  *	(indexed by TX power category)
581  * @psd_reg_client: maximum regulatory power spectral density, one value for
582  *	each 20 MHz subchannel per bss_conf's chanreq.oper
583  *	(indexed by TX power category)
584  */
585 struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe {
586 	struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe_eirp max_local[2], max_reg_client[2];
587 	struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe_psd psd_local[2], psd_reg_client[2];
588 };
589 
590 /**
591  * struct ieee80211_bss_conf - holds the BSS's changing parameters
592  *
593  * This structure keeps information about a BSS (and an association
594  * to that BSS) that can change during the lifetime of the BSS.
595  *
596  * @vif: reference to owning VIF
597  * @bss: the cfg80211 bss descriptor. Valid only for a station, and only
598  *	when associated. Note: This contains information which is not
599  *	necessarily authenticated. For example, information coming from probe
600  *	responses.
601  * @addr: (link) address used locally
602  * @link_id: link ID, or 0 for non-MLO
603  * @htc_trig_based_pkt_ext: default PE in 4us units, if BSS supports HE
604  * @uora_exists: is the UORA element advertised by AP
605  * @uora_ocw_range: UORA element's OCW Range field
606  * @frame_time_rts_th: HE duration RTS threshold, in units of 32us
607  * @he_support: does this BSS support HE
608  * @twt_requester: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
609  *	mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
610  * @twt_responder: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
611  *	mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
612  * @twt_protected: does this BSS support protected TWT frames
613  * @twt_broadcast: does this BSS support broadcast TWT
614  * @use_cts_prot: use CTS protection
615  * @use_short_preamble: use 802.11b short preamble
616  * @use_short_slot: use short slot time (only relevant for ERP)
617  * @dtim_period: num of beacons before the next DTIM, for beaconing,
618  *	valid in station mode only if after the driver was notified
619  *	with the %BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO flag, will be non-zero then.
620  * @sync_tsf: last beacon's/probe response's TSF timestamp (could be old
621  *	as it may have been received during scanning long ago). If the
622  *	HW flag %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY is set, then this can
623  *	only come from a beacon, but might not become valid until after
624  *	association when a beacon is received (which is notified with the
625  *	%BSS_CHANGED_DTIM flag.). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
626  * @sync_device_ts: the device timestamp corresponding to the sync_tsf,
627  *	the driver/device can use this to calculate synchronisation
628  *	(see @sync_tsf). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
629  * @sync_dtim_count: Only valid when %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY
630  *	is requested, see @sync_tsf/@sync_device_ts.
631  *	IMPORTANT: These three sync_* parameters would possibly be out of sync
632  *	by the time the driver will use them. The synchronized view is currently
633  *	guaranteed only in certain callbacks.
634  *	Note also that this is not used with MLD associations, mac80211 doesn't
635  *	know how to track beacons for all of the links for this.
636  * @beacon_int: beacon interval
637  * @assoc_capability: capabilities taken from assoc resp
638  * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates, each bit stands for an
639  *	index into the rate table configured by the driver in
640  *	the current band.
641  * @beacon_rate: associated AP's beacon TX rate
642  * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled)
643  * @bssid: The BSSID for this BSS
644  * @enable_beacon: whether beaconing should be enabled or not
645  * @chanreq: Channel request for this BSS -- the hardware might be
646  *	configured a higher bandwidth than this BSS uses, for example.
647  * @mu_group: VHT MU-MIMO group membership data
648  * @ht_operation_mode: HT operation mode like in &struct ieee80211_ht_operation.
649  *	This field is only valid when the channel is a wide HT/VHT channel.
650  *	Note that with TDLS this can be the case (channel is HT, protection must
651  *	be used from this field) even when the BSS association isn't using HT.
652  * @cqm_rssi_thold: Connection quality monitor RSSI threshold, a zero value
653  *	implies disabled. As with the cfg80211 callback, a change here should
654  *	cause an event to be sent indicating where the current value is in
655  *	relation to the newly configured threshold.
656  * @cqm_rssi_low: Connection quality monitor RSSI lower threshold, a zero value
657  *	implies disabled.  This is an alternative mechanism to the single
658  *	threshold event and can't be enabled simultaneously with it.
659  * @cqm_rssi_high: Connection quality monitor RSSI upper threshold.
660  * @cqm_rssi_hyst: Connection quality monitor RSSI hysteresis
661  * @qos: This is a QoS-enabled BSS.
662  * @hidden_ssid: The SSID of the current vif is hidden. Only valid in AP-mode.
663  * @txpower: TX power in dBm.  INT_MIN means not configured.
664  * @txpower_type: TX power adjustment used to control per packet Transmit
665  *	Power Control (TPC) in lower driver for the current vif. In particular
666  *	TPC is enabled if value passed in %txpower_type is
667  *	NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED (allow using less than specified from
668  *	userspace), whereas TPC is disabled if %txpower_type is set to
669  *	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED (use value configured from userspace)
670  * @p2p_noa_attr: P2P NoA attribute for P2P powersave
671  * @allow_p2p_go_ps: indication for AP or P2P GO interface, whether it's allowed
672  *	to use P2P PS mechanism or not. AP/P2P GO is not allowed to use P2P PS
673  *	if it has associated clients without P2P PS support.
674  * @max_idle_period: the time period during which the station can refrain from
675  *	transmitting frames to its associated AP without being disassociated.
676  *	In units of 1000 TUs. Zero value indicates that the AP did not include
677  *	a (valid) BSS Max Idle Period Element.
678  * @protected_keep_alive: if set, indicates that the station should send an RSN
679  *	protected frame to the AP to reset the idle timer at the AP for the
680  *	station.
681  * @ftm_responder: whether to enable or disable fine timing measurement FTM
682  *	responder functionality.
683  * @ftmr_params: configurable lci/civic parameter when enabling FTM responder.
684  * @nontransmitted: this BSS is a nontransmitted BSS profile
685  * @tx_bss_conf: Pointer to the BSS configuration of transmitting interface
686  *	if MBSSID is enabled. This pointer is RCU-protected due to CSA finish
687  *	and BSS color change flows accessing it.
688  * @transmitter_bssid: the address of transmitter AP
689  * @bssid_index: index inside the multiple BSSID set
690  * @bssid_indicator: 2^bssid_indicator is the maximum number of APs in set
691  * @ema_ap: AP supports enhancements of discovery and advertisement of
692  *	nontransmitted BSSIDs
693  * @profile_periodicity: the least number of beacon frames need to be received
694  *	in order to discover all the nontransmitted BSSIDs in the set.
695  * @he_oper: HE operation information of the BSS (AP/Mesh) or of the AP we are
696  *	connected to (STA)
697  * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection parameters.
698  * @he_bss_color: BSS coloring settings, if BSS supports HE
699  * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery configuration
700  * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
701  *	interval.
702  * @beacon_tx_rate: The configured beacon transmit rate that needs to be passed
703  *	to driver when rate control is offloaded to firmware.
704  * @power_type: power type of BSS for 6 GHz
705  * @tpe: transmit power envelope information
706  * @pwr_reduction: power constraint of BSS.
707  * @eht_support: does this BSS support EHT
708  * @epcs_support: does this BSS support EPCS
709  * @uhr_support: does this BSS support UHR
710  * @csa_active: marks whether a channel switch is going on.
711  * @mu_mimo_owner: indicates interface owns MU-MIMO capability
712  * @chanctx_conf: The channel context this interface is assigned to, or %NULL
713  *	when it is not assigned. This pointer is RCU-protected due to the TX
714  *	path needing to access it; even though the netdev carrier will always
715  *	be off when it is %NULL there can still be races and packets could be
716  *	processed after it switches back to %NULL.
717  * @color_change_active: marks whether a color change is ongoing.
718  * @color_change_color: the bss color that will be used after the change.
719  * @ht_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has HT LDPC capability.
720  * @vht_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has VHT LDPC capability.
721  * @he_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has HE LDPC capability.
722  * @vht_su_beamformer: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT SU
723  *	beamformer
724  * @vht_su_beamformee: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT SU
725  *	beamformee
726  * @vht_mu_beamformer: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT MU
727  *	beamformer
728  * @vht_mu_beamformee: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT MU
729  *	beamformee
730  * @he_su_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE SU
731  *	beamformer
732  * @he_su_beamformee: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE SU
733  *	beamformee
734  * @he_mu_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE MU
735  *	beamformer
736  * @he_full_ul_mumimo: does this BSS support the reception (AP) or transmission
737  *	(non-AP STA) of an HE TB PPDU on an RU that spans the entire PPDU
738  *	bandwidth
739  * @eht_su_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT SU
740  *	beamformer
741  * @eht_su_beamformee: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT SU
742  *	beamformee
743  * @eht_mu_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT MU
744  *	beamformer
745  * @eht_80mhz_full_bw_ul_mumimo: in AP-mode, does this BSS support the
746  *	reception of an EHT TB PPDU on an RU that spans the entire PPDU
747  *	bandwidth
748  * @eht_disable_mcs15: disable EHT-MCS 15 reception capability.
749  * @bss_param_ch_cnt: in BSS-mode, the BSS params change count. This
750  *	information is the latest known value. It can come from this link's
751  *	beacon or from a beacon sent by another link.
752  * @bss_param_ch_cnt_link_id: in BSS-mode, the link_id to which the beacon
753  *	that updated &bss_param_ch_cnt belongs. E.g. if link 1 doesn't hear
754  *	its beacons, and link 2 sent a beacon with an RNR element that updated
755  *	link 1's BSS params change count, then, link 1's
756  *	bss_param_ch_cnt_link_id will be 2. That means that link 1 knows that
757  *	link 2 was the link that updated its bss_param_ch_cnt value.
758  *	In case link 1 hears its beacon again, bss_param_ch_cnt_link_id will
759  *	be updated to 1, even if bss_param_ch_cnt didn't change. This allows
760  *	the link to know that it heard the latest value from its own beacon
761  *	(as opposed to hearing its value from another link's beacon).
762  * @s1g_long_beacon_period: number of beacon intervals between each long
763  *	beacon transmission.
764  */
765 struct ieee80211_bss_conf {
766 	struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
767 	struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
768 
769 	const u8 *bssid;
770 	unsigned int link_id;
771 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
772 	u8 htc_trig_based_pkt_ext;
773 	bool uora_exists;
774 	u8 uora_ocw_range;
775 	u16 frame_time_rts_th;
776 	bool he_support;
777 	bool twt_requester;
778 	bool twt_responder;
779 	bool twt_protected;
780 	bool twt_broadcast;
781 	/* erp related data */
782 	bool use_cts_prot;
783 	bool use_short_preamble;
784 	bool use_short_slot;
785 	bool enable_beacon;
786 	u8 dtim_period;
787 	u16 beacon_int;
788 	u16 assoc_capability;
789 	u64 sync_tsf;
790 	u32 sync_device_ts;
791 	u8 sync_dtim_count;
792 	u32 basic_rates;
793 	struct ieee80211_rate *beacon_rate;
794 	int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
795 	u16 ht_operation_mode;
796 	s32 cqm_rssi_thold;
797 	u32 cqm_rssi_hyst;
798 	s32 cqm_rssi_low;
799 	s32 cqm_rssi_high;
800 	struct ieee80211_chan_req chanreq;
801 	struct ieee80211_mu_group_data mu_group;
802 	bool qos;
803 	bool hidden_ssid;
804 	int txpower;
805 	enum nl80211_tx_power_setting txpower_type;
806 	struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr p2p_noa_attr;
807 	bool allow_p2p_go_ps;
808 	u16 max_idle_period;
809 	bool protected_keep_alive;
810 	bool ftm_responder;
811 	struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params *ftmr_params;
812 	/* Multiple BSSID data */
813 	bool nontransmitted;
814 	struct ieee80211_bss_conf __rcu *tx_bss_conf;
815 	u8 transmitter_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
816 	u8 bssid_index;
817 	u8 bssid_indicator;
818 	bool ema_ap;
819 	u8 profile_periodicity;
820 	struct {
821 		u32 params;
822 		u16 nss_set;
823 	} he_oper;
824 	struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd;
825 	struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color;
826 	struct ieee80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery;
827 	u32 unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval;
828 	struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_tx_rate;
829 	enum ieee80211_ap_reg_power power_type;
830 
831 	struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe tpe;
832 
833 	u8 pwr_reduction;
834 	bool eht_support;
835 	bool epcs_support;
836 	bool uhr_support;
837 
838 	bool csa_active;
839 
840 	bool mu_mimo_owner;
841 	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf __rcu *chanctx_conf;
842 
843 	bool color_change_active;
844 	u8 color_change_color;
845 
846 	bool ht_ldpc;
847 	bool vht_ldpc;
848 	bool he_ldpc;
849 	bool vht_su_beamformer;
850 	bool vht_su_beamformee;
851 	bool vht_mu_beamformer;
852 	bool vht_mu_beamformee;
853 	bool he_su_beamformer;
854 	bool he_su_beamformee;
855 	bool he_mu_beamformer;
856 	bool he_full_ul_mumimo;
857 	bool eht_su_beamformer;
858 	bool eht_su_beamformee;
859 	bool eht_mu_beamformer;
860 	bool eht_80mhz_full_bw_ul_mumimo;
861 	bool eht_disable_mcs15;
862 
863 	u8 bss_param_ch_cnt;
864 	u8 bss_param_ch_cnt_link_id;
865 
866 	u8 s1g_long_beacon_period;
867 };
868 
869 /**
870  * enum mac80211_tx_info_flags - flags to describe transmission information/status
871  *
872  * These flags are used with the @flags member of &ieee80211_tx_info.
873  *
874  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS: require TX status callback for this frame.
875  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ: The driver has to assign a sequence
876  *	number to this frame, taking care of not overwriting the fragment
877  *	number and increasing the sequence number only when the
878  *	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT flag is set. mac80211 will properly
879  *	assign sequence numbers to QoS-data frames but cannot do so correctly
880  *	for non-QoS-data and management frames because beacons need them from
881  *	that counter as well and mac80211 cannot guarantee proper sequencing.
882  *	If this flag is set, the driver should instruct the hardware to
883  *	assign a sequence number to the frame or assign one itself. Cf. IEEE
884  *	802.11-2007 7.1.3.4.1 paragraph 3. This flag will always be set for
885  *	beacons and always be clear for frames without a sequence number field.
886  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK: tell the low level not to wait for an ack
887  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT: clear powersave filter for destination
888  *	station
889  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT: this is a first fragment of the frame
890  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM: send this frame after DTIM beacon
891  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU: this frame should be sent as part of an A-MPDU
892  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED: Frame was injected, internal to mac80211.
893  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED: The frame was not transmitted
894  *	because the destination STA was in powersave mode. Note that to
895  *	avoid race conditions, the filter must be set by the hardware or
896  *	firmware upon receiving a frame that indicates that the station
897  *	went to sleep (must be done on device to filter frames already on
898  *	the queue) and may only be unset after mac80211 gives the OK for
899  *	that by setting the IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT (see above),
900  *	since only then is it guaranteed that no more frames are in the
901  *	hardware queue.
902  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK: Frame was acknowledged
903  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU: The frame was aggregated, so status
904  * 	is for the whole aggregation.
905  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK: no block ack was returned,
906  * 	so consider using block ack request (BAR).
907  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE: internal to mac80211, can be
908  *	set by rate control algorithms to indicate probe rate, will
909  *	be cleared for fragmented frames (except on the last fragment)
910  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK: Internal to mac80211. Used to indicate
911  *	that a frame can be transmitted while the queues are stopped for
912  *	off-channel operation.
913  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP: This frame uses hardware encapsulation
914  *	(header conversion)
915  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED: completely internal to mac80211,
916  *	used to indicate that a frame was already retried due to PS
917  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT: completely internal to mac80211,
918  *	used to indicate frame should not be encrypted
919  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER: This frame is a response to a poll
920  *	frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD) or a non-bufferable MMPDU and must
921  *	be sent although the station is in powersave mode.
922  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES: More frames will be passed to the
923  *	transmit function after the current frame, this can be used
924  *	by drivers to kick the DMA queue only if unset or when the
925  *	queue gets full.
926  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION: This frame is being retransmitted
927  *	after TX status because the destination was asleep, it must not
928  *	be modified again (no seqno assignment, crypto, etc.)
929  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX: This frame was transmitted by the MLME
930  *	code for connection establishment, this indicates that its status
931  *	should kick the MLME state machine.
932  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX: Frame was requested through nl80211
933  *	MLME command (internal to mac80211 to figure out whether to send TX
934  *	status to user space)
935  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC: tells the driver to use LDPC for this frame
936  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC: Enables Space-Time Block Coding (STBC) for this
937  *	frame and selects the maximum number of streams that it can use.
938  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN: Marks this packet to be transmitted on
939  *	the off-channel channel when a remain-on-channel offload is done
940  *	in hardware -- normal packets still flow and are expected to be
941  *	handled properly by the device.
942  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE: Marks this packet to be used for TKIP
943  *	testing. It will be sent out with incorrect Michael MIC key to allow
944  *	TKIP countermeasures to be tested.
945  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE: This frame will be sent at non CCK rate.
946  *	This flag is actually used for management frame especially for P2P
947  *	frames not being sent at CCK rate in 2GHz band.
948  * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP: This packet marks the end of service period,
949  *	when its status is reported the service period ends. For frames in
950  *	an SP that mac80211 transmits, it is already set; for driver frames
951  *	the driver may set this flag. It is also used to do the same for
952  *	PS-Poll responses.
953  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE: This frame will be sent at lowest rate.
954  *	This flag is used to send nullfunc frame at minimum rate when
955  *	the nullfunc is used for connection monitoring purpose.
956  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG: Don't fragment this packet even if it
957  *	would be fragmented by size (this is optional, only used for
958  *	monitor injection).
959  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED: A frame that was marked with
960  *	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK has been successfully transmitted without
961  *	any errors (like issues specific to the driver/HW).
962  *	This flag must not be set for frames that don't request no-ack
963  *	behaviour with IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK.
964  *
965  * Note: If you have to add new flags to the enumeration, then don't
966  *	 forget to update %IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS when necessary.
967  */
968 enum mac80211_tx_info_flags {
969 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS		= BIT(0),
970 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ		= BIT(1),
971 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK			= BIT(2),
972 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT		= BIT(3),
973 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT		= BIT(4),
974 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM	= BIT(5),
975 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU			= BIT(6),
976 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED		= BIT(7),
977 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED		= BIT(8),
978 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK			= BIT(9),
979 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU			= BIT(10),
980 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK		= BIT(11),
981 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE	= BIT(12),
982 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK	= BIT(13),
983 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP		= BIT(14),
984 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED		= BIT(15),
985 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT		= BIT(16),
986 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER		= BIT(17),
987 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES		= BIT(18),
988 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION	= BIT(19),
989 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX		= BIT(20),
990 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX	= BIT(21),
991 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC			= BIT(22),
992 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC			= BIT(23) | BIT(24),
993 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN		= BIT(25),
994 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE	= BIT(26),
995 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE		= BIT(27),
996 	IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP		= BIT(28),
997 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE		= BIT(29),
998 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG		= BIT(30),
999 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED	= BIT(31),
1000 };
1001 
1002 #define IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC_SHIFT		23
1003 
1004 #define IEEE80211_TX_RC_S1G_MCS IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS
1005 
1006 /**
1007  * enum mac80211_tx_control_flags - flags to describe transmit control
1008  *
1009  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO: this frame is a port control
1010  *	protocol frame (e.g. EAP)
1011  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE: This frame is a response to a poll
1012  *	frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD).
1013  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT: This frame is injected with rate information
1014  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU: This frame is an A-MSDU frame
1015  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT: This frame is going through the fast_xmit path
1016  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP: This frame skips mesh path lookup
1017  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING: completely internal to mac80211,
1018  *	used to indicate that a pending frame requires TX processing before
1019  *	it can be sent out.
1020  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO: Do not overwrite the sequence number that
1021  *	has already been assigned to this frame.
1022  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER: This frame should not be reordered
1023  *	relative to other frames that have this flag set, independent
1024  *	of their QoS TID or other priority field values.
1025  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX: first MLO TX, used mostly internally
1026  *	for sequence number assignment
1027  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_USE_RATE_MASK: Don't use rate mask for this frame
1028  *	which is transmitted due to scanning or offchannel TX, not in normal
1029  *	operation on the interface.
1030  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK: If not @IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, this
1031  *	frame should be transmitted on the specific link. This really is
1032  *	only relevant for frames that do not have data present, and is
1033  *	also not used for 802.3 format frames. Note that even if the frame
1034  *	is on a specific link, address translation might still apply if
1035  *	it's intended for an MLD.
1036  *
1037  * These flags are used in tx_info->control.flags.
1038  */
1039 enum mac80211_tx_control_flags {
1040 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO	= BIT(0),
1041 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE		= BIT(1),
1042 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT		= BIT(2),
1043 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU			= BIT(3),
1044 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT		= BIT(4),
1045 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP	= BIT(5),
1046 	IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING	= BIT(6),
1047 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO		= BIT(7),
1048 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER		= BIT(8),
1049 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX	= BIT(9),
1050 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_USE_RATE_MASK	= BIT(10),
1051 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK		= 0xf0000000,
1052 };
1053 
1054 #define IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED	0xf
1055 #define IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK_UNSPEC	\
1056 	u32_encode_bits(IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, \
1057 			IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK)
1058 
1059 /**
1060  * enum mac80211_tx_status_flags - flags to describe transmit status
1061  *
1062  * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID: ACK signal is valid
1063  *
1064  * These flags are used in tx_info->status.flags.
1065  */
1066 enum mac80211_tx_status_flags {
1067 	IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID = BIT(0),
1068 };
1069 
1070 /*
1071  * This definition is used as a mask to clear all temporary flags, which are
1072  * set by the tx handlers for each transmission attempt by the mac80211 stack.
1073  */
1074 #define IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS (IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK |		      \
1075 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT |    \
1076 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU |	      \
1077 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED |	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK |		      \
1078 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK |	      \
1079 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER |    \
1080 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC |		      \
1081 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC | IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
1082 
1083 /**
1084  * enum mac80211_rate_control_flags - per-rate flags set by the
1085  *	Rate Control algorithm.
1086  *
1087  * These flags are set by the Rate control algorithm for each rate during tx,
1088  * in the @flags member of struct ieee80211_tx_rate.
1089  *
1090  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS: Use RTS/CTS exchange for this rate.
1091  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT: CTS-to-self protection is required.
1092  *	This is set if the current BSS requires ERP protection.
1093  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Use short preamble.
1094  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS: HT rate.
1095  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS: VHT MCS rate, in this case the idx field is split
1096  *	into a higher 4 bits (Nss) and lower 4 bits (MCS number)
1097  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD: Indicates whether this rate should be used in
1098  *	Greenfield mode.
1099  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates if the Channel Width should be 40 MHz.
1100  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 80 MHz transmission
1101  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 160 MHz transmission
1102  *	(80+80 isn't supported yet)
1103  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA: The frame should be transmitted on both of the
1104  *	adjacent 20 MHz channels, if the current channel type is
1105  *	NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS or NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS.
1106  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI: Short Guard interval should be used for this rate.
1107  */
1108 enum mac80211_rate_control_flags {
1109 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS		= BIT(0),
1110 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT		= BIT(1),
1111 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE	= BIT(2),
1112 
1113 	/* rate index is an HT/VHT MCS instead of an index */
1114 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS			= BIT(3),
1115 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD		= BIT(4),
1116 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(5),
1117 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA		= BIT(6),
1118 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI		= BIT(7),
1119 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS			= BIT(8),
1120 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(9),
1121 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(10),
1122 };
1123 
1124 
1125 /* there are 40 bytes if you don't need the rateset to be kept */
1126 #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 40
1127 
1128 /* if you do need the rateset, then you have less space */
1129 #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 24
1130 
1131 /* maximum number of rate stages */
1132 #define IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES	4
1133 
1134 /* maximum number of rate table entries */
1135 #define IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE	4
1136 
1137 /**
1138  * struct ieee80211_tx_rate - rate selection/status
1139  *
1140  * @idx: rate index to attempt to send with
1141  * @flags: rate control flags (&enum mac80211_rate_control_flags)
1142  * @count: number of tries in this rate before going to the next rate
1143  *
1144  * A value of -1 for @idx indicates an invalid rate and, if used
1145  * in an array of retry rates, that no more rates should be tried.
1146  *
1147  * When used for transmit status reporting, the driver should
1148  * always report the rate along with the flags it used.
1149  *
1150  * &struct ieee80211_tx_info contains an array of these structs
1151  * in the control information, and it will be filled by the rate
1152  * control algorithm according to what should be sent. For example,
1153  * if this array contains, in the format { <idx>, <count> } the
1154  * information::
1155  *
1156  *    { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 4 }, { -1, 0 }, { -1, 0 }
1157  *
1158  * then this means that the frame should be transmitted
1159  * up to twice at rate 3, up to twice at rate 2, and up to four
1160  * times at rate 1 if it doesn't get acknowledged. Say it gets
1161  * acknowledged by the peer after the fifth attempt, the status
1162  * information should then contain::
1163  *
1164  *   { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 1 }, { -1, 0 } ...
1165  *
1166  * since it was transmitted twice at rate 3, twice at rate 2
1167  * and once at rate 1 after which we received an acknowledgement.
1168  */
1169 struct ieee80211_tx_rate {
1170 	s8 idx;
1171 	u16 count:5,
1172 	    flags:11;
1173 } __packed;
1174 
1175 #define IEEE80211_MAX_TX_RETRY		31
1176 
1177 static inline bool ieee80211_rate_valid(struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1178 {
1179 	return rate->idx >= 0 && rate->count > 0;
1180 }
1181 
1182 static inline void ieee80211_rate_set_vht(struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate,
1183 					  u8 mcs, u8 nss)
1184 {
1185 	WARN_ON(mcs & ~0xF);
1186 	WARN_ON((nss - 1) & ~0x7);
1187 	rate->idx = ((nss - 1) << 4) | mcs;
1188 }
1189 
1190 static inline u8
1191 ieee80211_rate_get_vht_mcs(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1192 {
1193 	return rate->idx & 0xF;
1194 }
1195 
1196 static inline u8
1197 ieee80211_rate_get_vht_nss(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1198 {
1199 	return (rate->idx >> 4) + 1;
1200 }
1201 
1202 /**
1203  * struct ieee80211_tx_info - skb transmit information
1204  *
1205  * This structure is placed in skb->cb for three uses:
1206  *  (1) mac80211 TX control - mac80211 tells the driver what to do
1207  *  (2) driver internal use (if applicable)
1208  *  (3) TX status information - driver tells mac80211 what happened
1209  *
1210  * @flags: transmit info flags, defined above
1211  * @band: the band to transmit on (use e.g. for checking for races),
1212  *	not valid if the interface is an MLD since we won't know which
1213  *	link the frame will be transmitted on
1214  * @hw_queue: HW queue to put the frame on, skb_get_queue_mapping() gives the AC
1215  * @status_data: internal data for TX status handling, assigned privately,
1216  *	see also &enum ieee80211_status_data for the internal documentation
1217  * @status_data_idr: indicates status data is IDR allocated ID for ack frame
1218  * @tx_time_est: TX time estimate in units of 4us, used internally
1219  * @control: union part for control data
1220  * @control.rates: TX rates array to try
1221  * @control.rts_cts_rate_idx: rate for RTS or CTS
1222  * @control.use_rts: use RTS
1223  * @control.use_cts_prot: use RTS/CTS
1224  * @control.short_preamble: use short preamble (CCK only)
1225  * @control.skip_table: skip externally configured rate table
1226  * @control.jiffies: timestamp for expiry on powersave clients
1227  * @control.vif: virtual interface (may be NULL)
1228  * @control.hw_key: key to encrypt with (may be NULL)
1229  * @control.flags: control flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_control_flags
1230  * @control.enqueue_time: enqueue time (for iTXQs)
1231  * @driver_rates: alias to @control.rates to reserve space
1232  * @pad: padding
1233  * @rate_driver_data: driver use area if driver needs @control.rates
1234  * @status: union part for status data
1235  * @status.rates: attempted rates
1236  * @status.ack_signal: ACK signal
1237  * @status.ampdu_ack_len: AMPDU ack length
1238  * @status.ampdu_len: AMPDU length
1239  * @status.antenna: (legacy, kept only for iwlegacy)
1240  * @status.tx_time: airtime consumed for transmission; note this is only
1241  *	used for WMM AC, not for airtime fairness
1242  * @status.flags: status flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_status_flags
1243  * @status.status_driver_data: driver use area
1244  * @ack: union part for pure ACK data
1245  * @ack.cookie: cookie for the ACK
1246  * @driver_data: array of driver_data pointers
1247  */
1248 struct ieee80211_tx_info {
1249 	/* common information */
1250 	u32 flags;
1251 	u32 band:3,
1252 	    status_data_idr:1,
1253 	    status_data:13,
1254 	    hw_queue:4,
1255 	    tx_time_est:10;
1256 	/* 1 free bit */
1257 
1258 	union {
1259 		struct {
1260 			union {
1261 				/* rate control */
1262 				struct {
1263 					struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[
1264 						IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1265 					s8 rts_cts_rate_idx;
1266 					u8 use_rts:1;
1267 					u8 use_cts_prot:1;
1268 					u8 short_preamble:1;
1269 					u8 skip_table:1;
1270 
1271 					/* for injection only (bitmap) */
1272 					u8 antennas:2;
1273 
1274 					/* 14 bits free */
1275 				};
1276 				/* only needed before rate control */
1277 				unsigned long jiffies;
1278 			};
1279 			/* NB: vif can be NULL for injected frames */
1280 			struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
1281 			struct ieee80211_key_conf *hw_key;
1282 			u32 flags;
1283 			codel_time_t enqueue_time;
1284 		} control;
1285 		struct {
1286 			u64 cookie;
1287 		} ack;
1288 		struct {
1289 			struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1290 			s32 ack_signal;
1291 			u8 ampdu_ack_len;
1292 			u8 ampdu_len;
1293 			u8 antenna;
1294 			u8 pad;
1295 			u16 tx_time;
1296 			u8 flags;
1297 			u8 pad2;
1298 			void *status_driver_data[16 / sizeof(void *)];
1299 		} status;
1300 		struct {
1301 			struct ieee80211_tx_rate driver_rates[
1302 				IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1303 			u8 pad[4];
1304 
1305 			void *rate_driver_data[
1306 				IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
1307 		};
1308 		void *driver_data[
1309 			IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
1310 	};
1311 };
1312 
1313 static inline u16
1314 ieee80211_info_set_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info, u16 tx_time_est)
1315 {
1316 	/* We only have 10 bits in tx_time_est, so store airtime
1317 	 * in increments of 4us and clamp the maximum to 2**12-1
1318 	 */
1319 	info->tx_time_est = min_t(u16, tx_time_est, 4095) >> 2;
1320 	return info->tx_time_est << 2;
1321 }
1322 
1323 static inline u16
1324 ieee80211_info_get_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1325 {
1326 	return info->tx_time_est << 2;
1327 }
1328 
1329 /***
1330  * struct ieee80211_rate_status - mrr stage for status path
1331  *
1332  * This struct is used in struct ieee80211_tx_status to provide drivers a
1333  * dynamic way to report about used rates and power levels per packet.
1334  *
1335  * @rate_idx The actual used rate.
1336  * @try_count How often the rate was tried.
1337  * @tx_power_idx An idx into the ieee80211_hw->tx_power_levels list of the
1338  * 	corresponding wifi hardware. The idx shall point to the power level
1339  * 	that was used when sending the packet.
1340  */
1341 struct ieee80211_rate_status {
1342 	struct rate_info rate_idx;
1343 	u8 try_count;
1344 	u8 tx_power_idx;
1345 };
1346 
1347 /**
1348  * struct ieee80211_tx_status - extended tx status info for rate control
1349  *
1350  * @sta: Station that the packet was transmitted for
1351  * @info: Basic tx status information
1352  * @skb: Packet skb (can be NULL if not provided by the driver)
1353  * @rates: Mrr stages that were used when sending the packet
1354  * @n_rates: Number of mrr stages (count of instances for @rates)
1355  * @free_list: list where processed skbs are stored to be free'd by the driver
1356  * @ack_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp of the received ack in nanoseconds
1357  *	Only needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action
1358  *	frames. Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled.
1359  */
1360 struct ieee80211_tx_status {
1361 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
1362 	struct ieee80211_tx_info *info;
1363 	struct sk_buff *skb;
1364 	struct ieee80211_rate_status *rates;
1365 	ktime_t ack_hwtstamp;
1366 	u8 n_rates;
1367 
1368 	struct list_head *free_list;
1369 };
1370 
1371 /**
1372  * struct ieee80211_scan_ies - descriptors for different blocks of IEs
1373  *
1374  * This structure is used to point to different blocks of IEs in HW scan
1375  * and scheduled scan. These blocks contain the IEs passed by userspace
1376  * and the ones generated by mac80211.
1377  *
1378  * @ies: pointers to band specific IEs.
1379  * @len: lengths of band_specific IEs.
1380  * @common_ies: IEs for all bands (especially vendor specific ones)
1381  * @common_ie_len: length of the common_ies
1382  */
1383 struct ieee80211_scan_ies {
1384 	const u8 *ies[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1385 	size_t len[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1386 	const u8 *common_ies;
1387 	size_t common_ie_len;
1388 };
1389 
1390 
1391 static inline struct ieee80211_tx_info *IEEE80211_SKB_CB(struct sk_buff *skb)
1392 {
1393 	return (struct ieee80211_tx_info *)skb->cb;
1394 }
1395 
1396 static inline struct ieee80211_rx_status *IEEE80211_SKB_RXCB(struct sk_buff *skb)
1397 {
1398 	return (struct ieee80211_rx_status *)skb->cb;
1399 }
1400 
1401 /**
1402  * ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status - clear TX status
1403  *
1404  * @info: The &struct ieee80211_tx_info to be cleared.
1405  *
1406  * When the driver passes an skb back to mac80211, it must report
1407  * a number of things in TX status. This function clears everything
1408  * in the TX status but the rate control information (it does clear
1409  * the count since you need to fill that in anyway).
1410  *
1411  * NOTE: While the rates array is kept intact, this will wipe all of the
1412  *	 driver_data fields in info, so it's up to the driver to restore
1413  *	 any fields it needs after calling this helper.
1414  */
1415 static inline void
1416 ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1417 {
1418 	int i;
1419 
1420 	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1421 		     offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, control.rates));
1422 	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1423 		     offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, driver_rates));
1424 	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) != 8);
1425 	/* clear the rate counts */
1426 	for (i = 0; i < IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES; i++)
1427 		info->status.rates[i].count = 0;
1428 	memset_after(&info->status, 0, rates);
1429 }
1430 
1431 
1432 /**
1433  * enum mac80211_rx_flags - receive flags
1434  *
1435  * These flags are used with the @flag member of &struct ieee80211_rx_status.
1436  * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR: Michael MIC error was reported on this frame.
1437  *	Use together with %RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED.
1438  * @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED: This frame was decrypted in hardware.
1439  * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED: the Michael MIC is stripped off this frame,
1440  *	verification has been done by the hardware.
1441  * @RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED: The IV and ICV are stripped from this frame.
1442  *	If this flag is set, the stack cannot do any replay detection
1443  *	hence the driver or hardware will have to do that.
1444  * @RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED: Currently only valid for CCMP/GCMP frames, this
1445  *	flag indicates that the PN was verified for replay protection.
1446  *	Note that this flag is also currently only supported when a frame
1447  *	is also decrypted (ie. @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED must be set)
1448  * @RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED: The driver should set this flag if it did
1449  *	de-duplication by itself.
1450  * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC: Set this flag if the FCS check failed on
1451  *	the frame.
1452  * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC: Set this flag if the PCLP check failed on
1453  *	the frame.
1454  * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1455  *	field) is valid if this field is non-zero, and the position
1456  *	where the timestamp was sampled depends on the value.
1457  * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1458  *	field) is valid and contains the time the first symbol of the MPDU
1459  *	was received. This is useful in monitor mode and for proper IBSS
1460  *	merging.
1461  * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1462  *	field) is valid and contains the time the last symbol of the MPDU
1463  *	(including FCS) was received.
1464  * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1465  *	field) is valid and contains the time the SYNC preamble was received.
1466  * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_IS_RTAP_TS64: The timestamp passed in the RX status @mactime
1467  *	is only for use in the radiotap timestamp header, not otherwise a valid
1468  *	@mactime value. Note this is a separate flag so that we continue to see
1469  *	%RX_FLAG_MACTIME as unset. Also note that in this case the timestamp is
1470  *	reported to be 64 bits wide, not just 32.
1471  * @RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL: The signal strength value is not present.
1472  *	Valid only for data frames (mainly A-MPDU)
1473  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS: A-MPDU details are known, in particular the reference
1474  *	number (@ampdu_reference) must be populated and be a distinct number for
1475  *	each A-MPDU
1476  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN: last subframe is known, should be set on all
1477  *	subframes of a single A-MPDU
1478  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST: this subframe is the last subframe of the A-MPDU
1479  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR: A delimiter CRC error has been detected
1480  *	on this subframe
1481  * @RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED: The mic was stripped of this packet. Decryption was
1482  *	done by the hardware
1483  * @RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR: Report frame only to monitor interfaces without
1484  *	processing it in any regular way.
1485  *	This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1486  *	them for sniffing purposes.
1487  * @RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR: Process and report frame to all interfaces except
1488  *	monitor interfaces.
1489  *	This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1490  *	them for sniffing purposes.
1491  * @RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE: Some drivers may prefer to report separate A-MSDU
1492  *	subframes instead of a one huge frame for performance reasons.
1493  *	All, but the last MSDU from an A-MSDU should have this flag set. E.g.
1494  *	if an A-MSDU has 3 frames, the first 2 must have the flag set, while
1495  *	the 3rd (last) one must not have this flag set. The flag is used to
1496  *	deal with retransmission/duplication recovery properly since A-MSDU
1497  *	subframes share the same sequence number. Reported subframes can be
1498  *	either regular MSDU or singly A-MSDUs. Subframes must not be
1499  *	interleaved with other frames.
1500  * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_TLV_AT_END: This frame contains radiotap TLVs in the
1501  *	skb->data (before the 802.11 header).
1502  *	If used, the SKB's mac_header pointer must be set to point
1503  *	to the 802.11 header after the TLVs, and any padding added after TLV
1504  *	data to align to 4 must be cleared by the driver putting the TLVs
1505  *	in the skb.
1506  * @RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN: Allow the same PN as same packet before.
1507  *	This is used for AMSDU subframes which can have the same PN as
1508  *	the first subframe.
1509  * @RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED: The ICV is stripped from this frame. CRC checking must
1510  *	be done in the hardware.
1511  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT: Value of the EOF bit in the A-MPDU delimiter for this
1512  *	frame
1513  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN: The EOF value is known
1514  * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE: HE radiotap data is present
1515  *	(&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he, mac80211 will fill in
1516  *
1517  *	 - DATA3_DATA_MCS
1518  *	 - DATA3_DATA_DCM
1519  *	 - DATA3_CODING
1520  *	 - DATA5_GI
1521  *	 - DATA5_DATA_BW_RU_ALLOC
1522  *	 - DATA6_NSTS
1523  *	 - DATA3_STBC
1524  *
1525  *	from the RX info data, so leave those zeroed when building this data)
1526  * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU: HE MU radiotap data is present
1527  *	(&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he_mu)
1528  * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG: L-SIG radiotap data is present
1529  * @RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU: use the frame only for radiotap reporting, with
1530  *	the "0-length PSDU" field included there.  The value for it is
1531  *	in &struct ieee80211_rx_status.  Note that if this value isn't
1532  *	known the frame shouldn't be reported.
1533  * @RX_FLAG_8023: the frame has an 802.3 header (decap offload performed by
1534  *	hardware or driver)
1535  * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_VHT: VHT radiotap data is present
1536  */
1537 enum mac80211_rx_flags {
1538 	RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR		= BIT(0),
1539 	RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED		= BIT(1),
1540 	RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR		= BIT(2),
1541 	RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED		= BIT(3),
1542 	RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED		= BIT(4),
1543 	RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC		= BIT(5),
1544 	RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC 	= BIT(6),
1545 	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_IS_RTAP_TS64	= BIT(7),
1546 	RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL		= BIT(8),
1547 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS		= BIT(9),
1548 	RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED		= BIT(10),
1549 	RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED		= BIT(11),
1550 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN	= BIT(12),
1551 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST		= BIT(13),
1552 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR	= BIT(14),
1553 	/* one free bit at 15 */
1554 	RX_FLAG_MACTIME			= BIT(16) | BIT(17),
1555 	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START	= 1 << 16,
1556 	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START		= 2 << 16,
1557 	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END		= 3 << 16,
1558 	RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR		= BIT(18),
1559 	RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE		= BIT(19),
1560 	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_TLV_AT_END	= BIT(20),
1561 	RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED		= BIT(21),
1562 	RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN		= BIT(22),
1563 	RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED		= BIT(23),
1564 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT		= BIT(24),
1565 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN	= BIT(25),
1566 	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE		= BIT(26),
1567 	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU		= BIT(27),
1568 	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG		= BIT(28),
1569 	RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU			= BIT(29),
1570 	RX_FLAG_8023			= BIT(30),
1571 	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_VHT		= BIT(31),
1572 };
1573 
1574 /**
1575  * enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags - MCS & bandwidth flags
1576  *
1577  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE: Short preamble was used for this frame
1578  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI: Short guard interval was used
1579  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF: This frame was received in a HT-greenfield transmission,
1580  *	if the driver fills this value it should add
1581  *	%IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_FMT
1582  *	to @hw.radiotap_mcs_details to advertise that fact.
1583  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC: LDPC was used
1584  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK: STBC 2 bit bitmask. 1 - Nss=1, 2 - Nss=2, 3 - Nss=3
1585  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_BF: packet was beamformed
1586  */
1587 enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags {
1588 	RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE		= BIT(0),
1589 	RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI		= BIT(2),
1590 	RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF		= BIT(3),
1591 	RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK		= BIT(4) | BIT(5),
1592 	RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC		= BIT(6),
1593 	RX_ENC_FLAG_BF			= BIT(7),
1594 };
1595 
1596 #define RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_SHIFT		4
1597 
1598 enum mac80211_rx_encoding {
1599 	RX_ENC_LEGACY = 0,
1600 	RX_ENC_HT,
1601 	RX_ENC_VHT,
1602 	RX_ENC_HE,
1603 	RX_ENC_EHT,
1604 	RX_ENC_UHR,
1605 };
1606 
1607 /**
1608  * struct ieee80211_rx_status - receive status
1609  *
1610  * The low-level driver should provide this information (the subset
1611  * supported by hardware) to the 802.11 code with each received
1612  * frame, in the skb's control buffer (cb).
1613  *
1614  * @mactime: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization Function
1615  * 	(TSF) timer when the first data symbol (MPDU) arrived at the hardware.
1616  * @boottime_ns: CLOCK_BOOTTIME timestamp the frame was received at, this is
1617  *	needed only for beacons and probe responses that update the scan cache.
1618  * @ack_tx_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp for the ack TX in nanoseconds. Only
1619  *	needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action frames.
1620  *	Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled.
1621  * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, mac80211 doesn't use
1622  *	it but can store it and pass it back to the driver for synchronisation
1623  * @band: the active band when this frame was received
1624  * @freq: frequency the radio was tuned to when receiving this frame, in MHz
1625  *	This field must be set for management frames, but isn't strictly needed
1626  *	for data (other) frames - for those it only affects radiotap reporting.
1627  * @freq_offset: @freq has a positive offset of 500Khz.
1628  * @signal: signal strength when receiving this frame, either in dBm, in dB or
1629  *	unspecified depending on the hardware capabilities flags
1630  *	@IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_*
1631  * @chains: bitmask of receive chains for which separate signal strength
1632  *	values were filled.
1633  * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength, in dBm (unlike @signal, doesn't
1634  *	support dB or unspecified units)
1635  * @antenna: antenna used
1636  * @rate_idx: index of data rate into band's supported rates or MCS index if
1637  *	HT or VHT is used (%RX_FLAG_HT/%RX_FLAG_VHT)
1638  * @nss: number of streams (VHT, HE, EHT and UHR only)
1639  * @flag: %RX_FLAG_\*
1640  * @encoding: &enum mac80211_rx_encoding
1641  * @bw: &enum rate_info_bw
1642  * @enc_flags: uses bits from &enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags
1643  * @he_ru: HE RU, from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc
1644  * @he_gi: HE GI, from &enum nl80211_he_gi
1645  * @he_dcm: HE DCM value
1646  * @eht: EHT specific rate information
1647  * @eht.ru: EHT RU, from &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc
1648  * @eht.gi: EHT GI, from &enum nl80211_eht_gi
1649  * @uhr: UHR specific rate information
1650  * @uhr.ru: UHR RU, from &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc
1651  * @uhr.gi: UHR GI, from &enum nl80211_eht_gi
1652  * @uhr.elr: UHR ELR MCS was used
1653  * @uhr.im: UHR interference mitigation was used
1654  * @rx_flags: internal RX flags for mac80211
1655  * @ampdu_reference: A-MPDU reference number, must be a different value for
1656  *	each A-MPDU but the same for each subframe within one A-MPDU
1657  * @zero_length_psdu_type: radiotap type of the 0-length PSDU
1658  * @link_valid: if the link which is identified by @link_id is valid. This flag
1659  *	is set only when connection is MLO.
1660  * @link_id: id of the link used to receive the packet. This is used along with
1661  *	@link_valid.
1662  */
1663 struct ieee80211_rx_status {
1664 	u64 mactime;
1665 	union {
1666 		u64 boottime_ns;
1667 		ktime_t ack_tx_hwtstamp;
1668 	};
1669 	u32 device_timestamp;
1670 	u32 ampdu_reference;
1671 	u32 flag;
1672 	u16 freq: 13, freq_offset: 1;
1673 	u8 enc_flags;
1674 	u8 encoding:3, bw:4;
1675 	union {
1676 		struct {
1677 			u8 he_ru:3;
1678 			u8 he_gi:2;
1679 			u8 he_dcm:1;
1680 		};
1681 		struct {
1682 			u8 ru:4;
1683 			u8 gi:2;
1684 		} eht;
1685 		struct {
1686 			u8 ru:4;
1687 			u8 gi:2;
1688 			u8 elr:1;
1689 			u8 im:1;
1690 		} uhr;
1691 	};
1692 	u8 rate_idx;
1693 	u8 nss;
1694 	u8 rx_flags;
1695 	u8 band;
1696 	u8 antenna;
1697 	s8 signal;
1698 	u8 chains;
1699 	s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
1700 	u8 zero_length_psdu_type;
1701 	u8 link_valid:1, link_id:4;
1702 };
1703 
1704 static inline u32
1705 ieee80211_rx_status_to_khz(struct ieee80211_rx_status *rx_status)
1706 {
1707 	return MHZ_TO_KHZ(rx_status->freq) +
1708 	       (rx_status->freq_offset ? 500 : 0);
1709 }
1710 
1711 /**
1712  * enum ieee80211_conf_flags - configuration flags
1713  *
1714  * Flags to define PHY configuration options
1715  *
1716  * @IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR: there's a monitor interface present -- use this
1717  *	to determine for example whether to calculate timestamps for packets
1718  *	or not, do not use instead of filter flags!
1719  * @IEEE80211_CONF_PS: Enable 802.11 power save mode (managed mode only).
1720  *	This is the power save mode defined by IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2,
1721  *	meaning that the hardware still wakes up for beacons, is able to
1722  *	transmit frames and receive the possible acknowledgment frames.
1723  *	Not to be confused with hardware specific wakeup/sleep states,
1724  *	driver is responsible for that. See the section "Powersave support"
1725  *	for more.
1726  * @IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE: The device is running, but idle; if the flag is set
1727  *	the driver should be prepared to handle configuration requests but
1728  *	may turn the device off as much as possible. Typically, this flag will
1729  *	be set when an interface is set UP but not associated or scanning, but
1730  *	it can also be unset in that case when monitor interfaces are active.
1731  * @IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL: The device is currently not on its main
1732  *	operating channel.
1733  */
1734 enum ieee80211_conf_flags {
1735 	IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR		= (1<<0),
1736 	IEEE80211_CONF_PS		= (1<<1),
1737 	IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE		= (1<<2),
1738 	IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL	= (1<<3),
1739 };
1740 
1741 
1742 /**
1743  * enum ieee80211_conf_changed - denotes which configuration changed
1744  *
1745  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL: the listen interval changed
1746  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR: the monitor flag changed
1747  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS: the PS flag or dynamic PS timeout changed
1748  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER: the TX power changed
1749  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL: the channel/channel_type changed
1750  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS: retry limits changed
1751  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE: Idle flag changed
1752  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS: Spatial multiplexing powersave mode changed
1753  *	Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1754  *	otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1755  */
1756 enum ieee80211_conf_changed {
1757 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS		= BIT(1),
1758 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL	= BIT(2),
1759 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR		= BIT(3),
1760 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS		= BIT(4),
1761 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER		= BIT(5),
1762 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL		= BIT(6),
1763 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS	= BIT(7),
1764 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE		= BIT(8),
1765 };
1766 
1767 /**
1768  * enum ieee80211_smps_mode - spatial multiplexing power save mode
1769  *
1770  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC: automatic
1771  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF: off
1772  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC: static
1773  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC: dynamic
1774  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES: internal, don't use
1775  */
1776 enum ieee80211_smps_mode {
1777 	IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC,
1778 	IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF,
1779 	IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC,
1780 	IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC,
1781 
1782 	/* keep last */
1783 	IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES,
1784 };
1785 
1786 /**
1787  * struct ieee80211_conf - configuration of the device
1788  *
1789  * This struct indicates how the driver shall configure the hardware.
1790  *
1791  * @flags: configuration flags defined above
1792  *
1793  * @listen_interval: listen interval in units of beacon interval
1794  * @ps_dtim_period: The DTIM period of the AP we're connected to, for use
1795  *	in power saving. Power saving will not be enabled until a beacon
1796  *	has been received and the DTIM period is known.
1797  * @dynamic_ps_timeout: The dynamic powersave timeout (in ms), see the
1798  *	powersave documentation below. This variable is valid only when
1799  *	the CONF_PS flag is set.
1800  *
1801  * @power_level: requested transmit power (in dBm), backward compatibility
1802  *	value only that is set to the minimum of all interfaces
1803  *
1804  * @chandef: the channel definition to tune to
1805  * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled
1806  *
1807  * @long_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "long" frame
1808  *	(a frame not RTS protected), called "dot11LongRetryLimit" in 802.11,
1809  *	but actually means the number of transmissions not the number of retries
1810  * @short_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "short"
1811  *	frame, called "dot11ShortRetryLimit" in 802.11, but actually means the
1812  *	number of transmissions not the number of retries
1813  *
1814  * @smps_mode: spatial multiplexing powersave mode; note that
1815  *	%IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC is used when the device is not
1816  *	configured for an HT channel.
1817  *	Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1818  *	otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1819  */
1820 struct ieee80211_conf {
1821 	u32 flags;
1822 	int power_level, dynamic_ps_timeout;
1823 
1824 	u16 listen_interval;
1825 	u8 ps_dtim_period;
1826 
1827 	u8 long_frame_max_tx_count, short_frame_max_tx_count;
1828 
1829 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1830 	bool radar_enabled;
1831 	enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
1832 };
1833 
1834 /**
1835  * struct ieee80211_channel_switch - holds the channel switch data
1836  *
1837  * The information provided in this structure is required for channel switch
1838  * operation.
1839  *
1840  * @timestamp: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization
1841  *	Function (TSF) timer when the frame containing the channel switch
1842  *	announcement was received. This is simply the rx.mactime parameter
1843  *	the driver passed into mac80211.
1844  * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, this is the
1845  *	rx.device_timestamp parameter the driver passed to mac80211.
1846  * @block_tx: Indicates whether transmission must be blocked before the
1847  *	scheduled channel switch, as indicated by the AP.
1848  * @chandef: the new channel to switch to
1849  * @count: the number of TBTT's until the channel switch event
1850  * @delay: maximum delay between the time the AP transmitted the last beacon in
1851  *	current channel and the expected time of the first beacon in the new
1852  *	channel, expressed in TU.
1853  * @link_id: the link ID of the link doing the channel switch, 0 for non-MLO
1854  */
1855 struct ieee80211_channel_switch {
1856 	u64 timestamp;
1857 	u32 device_timestamp;
1858 	bool block_tx;
1859 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1860 	u8 count;
1861 	u8 link_id;
1862 	u32 delay;
1863 };
1864 
1865 /**
1866  * enum ieee80211_vif_flags - virtual interface flags
1867  *
1868  * @IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER: the device performs beacon filtering
1869  *	on this virtual interface to avoid unnecessary CPU wakeups
1870  * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI: the device can do connection quality
1871  *	monitoring on this virtual interface -- i.e. it can monitor
1872  *	connection quality related parameters, such as the RSSI level and
1873  *	provide notifications if configured trigger levels are reached.
1874  * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD: The device can do U-APSD for this
1875  *	interface. This flag should be set during interface addition,
1876  *	but may be set/cleared as late as authentication to an AP. It is
1877  *	only valid for managed/station mode interfaces.
1878  * @IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE: request to handle NOA attributes
1879  *	and send P2P_PS notification to the driver if NOA changed, even
1880  *	this is not pure P2P vif.
1881  * @IEEE80211_VIF_EML_ACTIVE: The driver indicates that EML operation is
1882  *      enabled for the interface.
1883  * @IEEE80211_VIF_IGNORE_OFDMA_WIDER_BW: Ignore wider bandwidth OFDMA
1884  *	operation on this interface and request a channel context without
1885  *	the AP definition. Use this e.g. because the device is able to
1886  *	handle OFDMA (downlink and trigger for uplink) on a per-AP basis.
1887  * @IEEE80211_VIF_REMOVE_AP_AFTER_DISASSOC: indicates that the AP sta should
1888  *	be removed only after setting the vif as unassociated, and not the
1889  *	opposite. Only relevant for STA vifs.
1890  */
1891 enum ieee80211_vif_flags {
1892 	IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER		= BIT(0),
1893 	IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI		= BIT(1),
1894 	IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD		= BIT(2),
1895 	IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE		= BIT(3),
1896 	IEEE80211_VIF_EML_ACTIVE	        = BIT(4),
1897 	IEEE80211_VIF_IGNORE_OFDMA_WIDER_BW	= BIT(5),
1898 	IEEE80211_VIF_REMOVE_AP_AFTER_DISASSOC	= BIT(6),
1899 };
1900 
1901 
1902 /**
1903  * enum ieee80211_offload_flags - virtual interface offload flags
1904  *
1905  * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED: tx encapsulation offload is enabled
1906  *	The driver supports sending frames passed as 802.3 frames by mac80211.
1907  *	It must also support sending 802.11 packets for the same interface.
1908  * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR: support 4-address mode encapsulation offload
1909  * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED: rx encapsulation offload is enabled
1910  *	The driver supports passing received 802.11 frames as 802.3 frames to
1911  *	mac80211.
1912  */
1913 
1914 enum ieee80211_offload_flags {
1915 	IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED		= BIT(0),
1916 	IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR		= BIT(1),
1917 	IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED		= BIT(2),
1918 };
1919 
1920 /**
1921  * struct ieee80211_eml_params - EHT Operating mode notification parameters
1922  *
1923  * EML Operating mode notification parameters received in the Operating mode
1924  * notification frame. This struct is used as a container to pass the info to
1925  * the underlay driver.
1926  *
1927  * @link_id: the link ID where the Operating mode notification frame has been
1928  *	received.
1929  * @control: EML control field defined in P802.11be section 9.4.1.76.
1930  * @link_bitmap: eMLSR/eMLMR enabled links defined in P802.11be
1931  *	section 9.4.1.76.
1932  * @emlmr_mcs_map_count: eMLMR number of valid mcs_map_bw fields according to
1933  *	P802.11be section 9.4.1.76 (valid if eMLMR mode control bit is set).
1934  * @emlmr_mcs_map_bw: eMLMR supported MCS and NSS set subfileds defined in
1935  *	P802.11be section 9.4.1.76 (valid if eMLMR mode control bit is set).
1936  */
1937 struct ieee80211_eml_params {
1938 	u8 link_id;
1939 	u8 control;
1940 	u16 link_bitmap;
1941 	u8 emlmr_mcs_map_count;
1942 	u8 emlmr_mcs_map_bw[9];
1943 };
1944 
1945 /**
1946  * struct ieee80211_vif_cfg - interface configuration
1947  * @assoc: association status
1948  * @ibss_joined: indicates whether this station is part of an IBSS or not
1949  * @ibss_creator: indicates if a new IBSS network is being created
1950  * @ps: power-save mode (STA only). This flag is NOT affected by
1951  *	offchannel/dynamic_ps operations.
1952  * @aid: association ID number, valid only when @assoc is true
1953  * @eml_cap: EML capabilities as described in P802.11be_D4.1 Figure 9-1001j.
1954  * @eml_med_sync_delay: Medium Synchronization delay as described in
1955  *	P802.11be_D4.1 Figure 9-1001i.
1956  * @mld_capa_op: MLD Capabilities and Operations per P802.11be_D4.1
1957  *	Figure 9-1001k
1958  * @arp_addr_list: List of IPv4 addresses for hardware ARP filtering. The
1959  *	may filter ARP queries targeted for other addresses than listed here.
1960  *	The driver must allow ARP queries targeted for all address listed here
1961  *	to pass through. An empty list implies no ARP queries need to pass.
1962  * @arp_addr_cnt: Number of addresses currently on the list. Note that this
1963  *	may be larger than %IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN (the arp_addr_list
1964  *	array size), it's up to the driver what to do in that case.
1965  * @ssid: The SSID of the current vif. Valid in AP and IBSS mode.
1966  * @ssid_len: Length of SSID given in @ssid.
1967  * @s1g: BSS is S1G BSS (affects Association Request format).
1968  * @idle: This interface is idle. There's also a global idle flag in the
1969  *	hardware config which may be more appropriate depending on what
1970  *	your driver/device needs to do.
1971  * @ap_addr: AP MLD address, or BSSID for non-MLO connections
1972  *	(station mode only)
1973  */
1974 struct ieee80211_vif_cfg {
1975 	/* association related data */
1976 	bool assoc, ibss_joined;
1977 	bool ibss_creator;
1978 	bool ps;
1979 	u16 aid;
1980 	u16 eml_cap;
1981 	u16 eml_med_sync_delay;
1982 	u16 mld_capa_op;
1983 
1984 	__be32 arp_addr_list[IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN];
1985 	int arp_addr_cnt;
1986 	u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
1987 	size_t ssid_len;
1988 	bool s1g;
1989 	bool idle;
1990 	u8 ap_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
1991 };
1992 
1993 #define IEEE80211_TTLM_NUM_TIDS 8
1994 
1995 /**
1996  * struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm - negotiated TID to link map info
1997  *
1998  * @downlink: bitmap of active links per TID for downlink, or 0 if mapping for
1999  *	this TID is not included.
2000  * @uplink: bitmap of active links per TID for uplink, or 0 if mapping for this
2001  *	TID is not included.
2002  * @valid: info is valid or not.
2003  */
2004 struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm {
2005 	u16 downlink[IEEE80211_TTLM_NUM_TIDS];
2006 	u16 uplink[IEEE80211_TTLM_NUM_TIDS];
2007 	bool valid;
2008 };
2009 
2010 /**
2011  * enum ieee80211_neg_ttlm_res - return value for negotiated TTLM handling
2012  * @NEG_TTLM_RES_ACCEPT: accept the request
2013  * @NEG_TTLM_RES_REJECT: reject the request
2014  * @NEG_TTLM_RES_SUGGEST_PREFERRED: reject and suggest a new mapping
2015  */
2016 enum ieee80211_neg_ttlm_res {
2017 	NEG_TTLM_RES_ACCEPT,
2018 	NEG_TTLM_RES_REJECT,
2019 	NEG_TTLM_RES_SUGGEST_PREFERRED
2020 };
2021 
2022 /**
2023  * struct ieee80211_vif - per-interface data
2024  *
2025  * Data in this structure is continually present for driver
2026  * use during the life of a virtual interface.
2027  *
2028  * @type: type of this virtual interface
2029  * @cfg: vif configuration, see &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg
2030  * @bss_conf: BSS configuration for this interface, either our own
2031  *	or the BSS we're associated to
2032  * @link_conf: in case of MLD, the per-link BSS configuration,
2033  *	indexed by link ID
2034  * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO.
2035  * @active_links: The bitmap of active links, or 0 for non-MLO.
2036  *	The driver shouldn't change this directly, but use the
2037  *	API calls meant for that purpose.
2038  * @dormant_links: subset of the valid links that are disabled/suspended
2039  *	due to advertised or negotiated TTLM respectively.
2040  *	0 for non-MLO.
2041  * @suspended_links: subset of dormant_links representing links that are
2042  *	suspended due to negotiated TTLM, and could be activated in the
2043  *	future by tearing down the TTLM negotiation.
2044  *	0 for non-MLO.
2045  * @neg_ttlm: negotiated TID to link mapping info.
2046  *	see &struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm.
2047  * @addr: address of this interface
2048  * @addr_valid: indicates if the address is actively used. Set to false for
2049  *	passive monitor interfaces, true in all other cases.
2050  * @p2p: indicates whether this AP or STA interface is a p2p
2051  *	interface, i.e. a GO or p2p-sta respectively
2052  * @netdev_features: tx netdev features supported by the hardware for this
2053  *	vif. mac80211 initializes this to hw->netdev_features, and the driver
2054  *	can mask out specific tx features. mac80211 will handle software fixup
2055  *	for masked offloads (GSO, CSUM)
2056  * @driver_flags: flags/capabilities the driver has for this interface,
2057  *	these need to be set (or cleared) when the interface is added
2058  *	or, if supported by the driver, the interface type is changed
2059  *	at runtime, mac80211 will never touch this field
2060  * @offload_flags: hardware offload capabilities/flags for this interface.
2061  *	These are initialized by mac80211 before calling .add_interface,
2062  *	.change_interface or .update_vif_offload and updated by the driver
2063  *	within these ops, based on supported features or runtime change
2064  *	restrictions.
2065  * @hw_queue: hardware queue for each AC
2066  * @cab_queue: content-after-beacon (DTIM beacon really) queue, AP mode only
2067  * @debugfs_dir: debugfs dentry, can be used by drivers to create own per
2068  *	interface debug files. Note that it will be NULL for the virtual
2069  *	monitor interface (if that is requested.)
2070  * @probe_req_reg: probe requests should be reported to mac80211 for this
2071  *	interface.
2072  * @rx_mcast_action_reg: multicast Action frames should be reported to mac80211
2073  *	for this interface.
2074  * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
2075  *	sizeof(void \*).
2076  * @txq: the multicast data TX queue
2077  * @offload_flags: 802.3 -> 802.11 enapsulation offload flags, see
2078  *	&enum ieee80211_offload_flags.
2079  */
2080 struct ieee80211_vif {
2081 	enum nl80211_iftype type;
2082 	struct ieee80211_vif_cfg cfg;
2083 	struct ieee80211_bss_conf bss_conf;
2084 	struct ieee80211_bss_conf __rcu *link_conf[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
2085 	u16 valid_links, active_links, dormant_links, suspended_links;
2086 	struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm neg_ttlm;
2087 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2088 	bool addr_valid;
2089 	bool p2p;
2090 
2091 	u8 cab_queue;
2092 	u8 hw_queue[IEEE80211_NUM_ACS];
2093 
2094 	struct ieee80211_txq *txq;
2095 
2096 	netdev_features_t netdev_features;
2097 	u32 driver_flags;
2098 	u32 offload_flags;
2099 
2100 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
2101 	struct dentry *debugfs_dir;
2102 #endif
2103 
2104 	bool probe_req_reg;
2105 	bool rx_mcast_action_reg;
2106 
2107 	/* must be last */
2108 	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2109 };
2110 
2111 /**
2112  * ieee80211_vif_usable_links - Return the usable links for the vif
2113  * @vif: the vif for which the usable links are requested
2114  * Return: the usable link bitmap
2115  */
2116 static inline u16 ieee80211_vif_usable_links(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
2117 {
2118 	return vif->valid_links & ~vif->dormant_links;
2119 }
2120 
2121 /**
2122  * ieee80211_vif_is_mld - Returns true iff the vif is an MLD one
2123  * @vif: the vif
2124  * Return: %true if the vif is an MLD, %false otherwise.
2125  */
2126 static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mld(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
2127 {
2128 	/* valid_links != 0 indicates this vif is an MLD */
2129 	return vif->valid_links != 0;
2130 }
2131 
2132 /**
2133  * ieee80211_vif_link_active - check if a given link is active
2134  * @vif: the vif
2135  * @link_id: the link ID to check
2136  * Return: %true if the vif is an MLD and the link is active, or if
2137  *	the vif is not an MLD and the link ID is 0; %false otherwise.
2138  */
2139 static inline bool ieee80211_vif_link_active(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
2140 					     unsigned int link_id)
2141 {
2142 	if (!ieee80211_vif_is_mld(vif))
2143 		return link_id == 0;
2144 	return vif->active_links & BIT(link_id);
2145 }
2146 
2147 #define for_each_vif_active_link(vif, link, link_id)				\
2148 	for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((vif)->link_conf); link_id++)	\
2149 		if ((!(vif)->active_links ||					\
2150 		     (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) &&			\
2151 		    (link = link_conf_dereference_check(vif, link_id)))
2152 
2153 static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mesh(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
2154 {
2155 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_MESH
2156 	return vif->type == NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT;
2157 #endif
2158 	return false;
2159 }
2160 
2161 /**
2162  * wdev_to_ieee80211_vif - return a vif struct from a wdev
2163  * @wdev: the wdev to get the vif for
2164  *
2165  * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
2166  * (like the vendor commands) that get a wdev.
2167  *
2168  * Return: pointer to the wdev, or %NULL if the given wdev isn't
2169  * associated with a vif that the driver knows about (e.g. monitor
2170  * or AP_VLAN interfaces.)
2171  */
2172 struct ieee80211_vif *wdev_to_ieee80211_vif(struct wireless_dev *wdev);
2173 
2174 /**
2175  * ieee80211_vif_to_wdev - return a wdev struct from a vif
2176  * @vif: the vif to get the wdev for
2177  *
2178  * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
2179  * (like the vendor commands) that needs to get the wdev for a vif.
2180  * This can also be useful to get the netdev associated to a vif.
2181  *
2182  * Return: pointer to the wdev
2183  */
2184 struct wireless_dev *ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
2185 
2186 static inline bool lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
2187 {
2188 	return lockdep_is_held(&ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(vif)->wiphy->mtx);
2189 }
2190 
2191 #define link_conf_dereference_protected(vif, link_id)		\
2192 	rcu_dereference_protected((vif)->link_conf[link_id],	\
2193 				  lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(vif))
2194 
2195 #define link_conf_dereference_check(vif, link_id)		\
2196 	rcu_dereference_check((vif)->link_conf[link_id],	\
2197 			      lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(vif))
2198 
2199 /**
2200  * enum ieee80211_key_flags - key flags
2201  *
2202  * These flags are used for communication about keys between the driver
2203  * and mac80211, with the @flags parameter of &struct ieee80211_key_conf.
2204  *
2205  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV: This flag should be set by the
2206  *	driver to indicate that it requires IV generation for this
2207  *	particular key. Setting this flag does not necessarily mean that SKBs
2208  *	will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or MIC.
2209  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC: This flag should be set by
2210  *	the driver for a TKIP key if it requires Michael MIC
2211  *	generation in software.
2212  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE: Set by mac80211, this flag indicates
2213  *	that the key is pairwise rather then a shared key.
2214  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX: This flag should be set by the driver for a
2215  *	CCMP/GCMP key if it requires CCMP/GCMP encryption of management frames
2216  *	(MFP) to be done in software.
2217  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver
2218  *	if space should be prepared for the IV, but the IV
2219  *	itself should not be generated. Do not set together with
2220  *	@IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV on the same key. Setting this flag does
2221  *	not necessarily mean that SKBs will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or
2222  *	MIC.
2223  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT: This key will be used to decrypt received
2224  *	management frames. The flag can help drivers that have a hardware
2225  *	crypto implementation that doesn't deal with management frames
2226  *	properly by allowing them to not upload the keys to hardware and
2227  *	fall back to software crypto. Note that this flag deals only with
2228  *	RX, if your crypto engine can't deal with TX you can also set the
2229  *	%IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX flag to encrypt such frames in SW.
2230  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT: This flag should be set by the
2231  *	driver for a CCMP/GCMP key to indicate that is requires IV generation
2232  *	only for management frames (MFP).
2233  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM: This flag should be set by the
2234  *	driver for a key to indicate that sufficient tailroom must always
2235  *	be reserved for ICV or MIC, even when HW encryption is enabled.
2236  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver for
2237  *	a TKIP key if it only requires MIC space. Do not set together with
2238  *	@IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC on the same key.
2239  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX: Key needs explicit Tx activation.
2240  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE: This flag should be set by the driver
2241  *	for a AES_CMAC or a AES_GMAC key to indicate that it requires sequence
2242  *	number generation only
2243  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SPP_AMSDU: SPP A-MSDUs can be used with this key
2244  *	(set by mac80211 from the sta->spp_amsdu flag)
2245  */
2246 enum ieee80211_key_flags {
2247 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT	= BIT(0),
2248 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV		= BIT(1),
2249 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC	= BIT(2),
2250 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE		= BIT(3),
2251 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX		= BIT(4),
2252 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE		= BIT(5),
2253 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT		= BIT(6),
2254 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM	= BIT(7),
2255 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE	= BIT(8),
2256 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX		= BIT(9),
2257 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE	= BIT(10),
2258 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SPP_AMSDU		= BIT(11),
2259 };
2260 
2261 /**
2262  * struct ieee80211_key_conf - key information
2263  *
2264  * This key information is given by mac80211 to the driver by
2265  * the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops.
2266  *
2267  * @hw_key_idx: To be set by the driver, this is the key index the driver
2268  *	wants to be given when a frame is transmitted and needs to be
2269  *	encrypted in hardware.
2270  * @cipher: The key's cipher suite selector.
2271  * @tx_pn: PN used for TX keys, may be used by the driver as well if it
2272  *	needs to do software PN assignment by itself (e.g. due to TSO)
2273  * @flags: key flags, see &enum ieee80211_key_flags.
2274  * @keyidx: the key index (0-7)
2275  * @keylen: key material length
2276  * @key: key material. For ALG_TKIP the key is encoded as a 256-bit (32 byte)
2277  * 	data block:
2278  * 	- Temporal Encryption Key (128 bits)
2279  * 	- Temporal Authenticator Tx MIC Key (64 bits)
2280  * 	- Temporal Authenticator Rx MIC Key (64 bits)
2281  * @icv_len: The ICV length for this key type
2282  * @iv_len: The IV length for this key type
2283  * @link_id: the link ID, 0 for non-MLO, or -1 for pairwise keys
2284  */
2285 struct ieee80211_key_conf {
2286 	atomic64_t tx_pn;
2287 	u32 cipher;
2288 	u8 icv_len;
2289 	u8 iv_len;
2290 	u8 hw_key_idx;
2291 	s8 keyidx;
2292 	u16 flags;
2293 	s8 link_id;
2294 	u8 keylen;
2295 	u8 key[];
2296 };
2297 
2298 #define IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN	16
2299 
2300 #define TKIP_PN_TO_IV16(pn) ((u16)(pn & 0xffff))
2301 #define TKIP_PN_TO_IV32(pn) ((u32)((pn >> 16) & 0xffffffff))
2302 
2303 /**
2304  * struct ieee80211_key_seq - key sequence counter
2305  *
2306  * @tkip: TKIP data, containing IV32 and IV16 in host byte order
2307  * @ccmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2308  *	reverse order than in packet)
2309  * @aes_cmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2310  *	reverse order than in packet)
2311  * @aes_gmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2312  *	reverse order than in packet)
2313  * @gcmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2314  *	reverse order than in packet)
2315  * @hw: data for HW-only (e.g. cipher scheme) keys
2316  */
2317 struct ieee80211_key_seq {
2318 	union {
2319 		struct {
2320 			u32 iv32;
2321 			u16 iv16;
2322 		} tkip;
2323 		struct {
2324 			u8 pn[6];
2325 		} ccmp;
2326 		struct {
2327 			u8 pn[6];
2328 		} aes_cmac;
2329 		struct {
2330 			u8 pn[6];
2331 		} aes_gmac;
2332 		struct {
2333 			u8 pn[6];
2334 		} gcmp;
2335 		struct {
2336 			u8 seq[IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN];
2337 			u8 seq_len;
2338 		} hw;
2339 	};
2340 };
2341 
2342 /**
2343  * enum set_key_cmd - key command
2344  *
2345  * Used with the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
2346  * indicates whether a key is being removed or added.
2347  *
2348  * @SET_KEY: a key is set
2349  * @DISABLE_KEY: a key must be disabled
2350  */
2351 enum set_key_cmd {
2352 	SET_KEY, DISABLE_KEY,
2353 };
2354 
2355 /**
2356  * enum ieee80211_sta_state - station state
2357  *
2358  * @IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST: station doesn't exist at all,
2359  *	this is a special state for add/remove transitions
2360  * @IEEE80211_STA_NONE: station exists without special state
2361  * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTH: station is authenticated
2362  * @IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC: station is associated
2363  * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED: station is authorized (802.1X)
2364  */
2365 enum ieee80211_sta_state {
2366 	/* NOTE: These need to be ordered correctly! */
2367 	IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST,
2368 	IEEE80211_STA_NONE,
2369 	IEEE80211_STA_AUTH,
2370 	IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC,
2371 	IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED,
2372 };
2373 
2374 /**
2375  * enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth - station RX bandwidth
2376  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20: station can only receive 20 MHz
2377  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40: station can receive up to 40 MHz
2378  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80: station can receive up to 80 MHz
2379  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160: station can receive up to 160 MHz
2380  *	(including 80+80 MHz)
2381  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320: station can receive up to 320 MHz
2382  *
2383  * Implementation note: 20 must be zero to be initialized
2384  *	correctly, the values must be sorted.
2385  */
2386 enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth {
2387 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20 = 0,
2388 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40,
2389 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80,
2390 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160,
2391 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320,
2392 };
2393 
2394 #define IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_MAX	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320
2395 
2396 /**
2397  * struct ieee80211_sta_rates - station rate selection table
2398  *
2399  * @rcu_head: RCU head used for freeing the table on update
2400  * @rate: transmit rates/flags to be used by default.
2401  *	Overriding entries per-packet is possible by using cb tx control.
2402  */
2403 struct ieee80211_sta_rates {
2404 	struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2405 	struct {
2406 		s8 idx;
2407 		u8 count;
2408 		u8 count_cts;
2409 		u8 count_rts;
2410 		u16 flags;
2411 	} rate[IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE];
2412 };
2413 
2414 /**
2415  * struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration
2416  *
2417  * Used to configure txpower for station.
2418  *
2419  * @power: indicates the tx power, in dBm, to be used when sending data frames
2420  *	to the STA.
2421  * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power
2422  *	will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC
2423  *	%type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power.
2424  *	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for
2425  *	per peer TPC.
2426  */
2427 struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr {
2428 	s16 power;
2429 	enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type;
2430 };
2431 
2432 /**
2433  * struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates - info that is aggregated from active links
2434  *
2435  * Used for any per-link data that needs to be aggregated and updated in the
2436  * main &struct ieee80211_sta when updated or the active links change.
2437  *
2438  * @max_amsdu_len: indicates the maximal length of an A-MSDU in bytes.
2439  *	This field is always valid for packets with a VHT preamble.
2440  *	For packets with a HT preamble, additional limits apply:
2441  *
2442  *	* If the skb is transmitted as part of a BA agreement, the
2443  *	  A-MSDU maximal size is min(max_amsdu_len, 4065) bytes.
2444  *	* If the skb is not part of a BA agreement, the A-MSDU maximal
2445  *	  size is min(max_amsdu_len, 7935) bytes.
2446  *
2447  * Both additional HT limits must be enforced by the low level
2448  * driver. This is defined by the spec (IEEE 802.11-2012 section
2449  * 8.3.2.2 NOTE 2).
2450  * @max_rc_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes recommended by rate control.
2451  * @max_tid_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes for this TID
2452  */
2453 struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates {
2454 	u16 max_amsdu_len;
2455 
2456 	u16 max_rc_amsdu_len;
2457 	u16 max_tid_amsdu_len[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS];
2458 };
2459 
2460 /**
2461  * struct ieee80211_link_sta - station Link specific info
2462  * All link specific info for a STA link for a non MLD STA(single)
2463  * or a MLD STA(multiple entries) are stored here.
2464  *
2465  * @sta: reference to owning STA
2466  * @addr: MAC address of the Link STA. For non-MLO STA this is same as the addr
2467  *	in ieee80211_sta. For MLO Link STA this addr can be same or different
2468  *	from addr in ieee80211_sta (representing MLD STA addr)
2469  * @link_id: the link ID for this link STA (0 for deflink)
2470  * @smps_mode: current SMPS mode (off, static or dynamic)
2471  * @supp_rates: Bitmap of supported rates
2472  * @ht_cap: HT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
2473  * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
2474  * @he_cap: HE capabilities of this STA
2475  * @he_6ghz_capa: on 6 GHz, holds the HE 6 GHz band capabilities
2476  * @eht_cap: EHT capabilities of this STA
2477  * @uhr_cap: UHR capabilities of this STA
2478  * @s1g_cap: S1G capabilities of this STA
2479  * @agg: per-link data for multi-link aggregation
2480  * @bandwidth: current bandwidth the station can receive with
2481  * @rx_nss: in HT/VHT, the maximum number of spatial streams the
2482  *	station can receive at the moment, changed by operating mode
2483  *	notifications and capabilities. The value is only valid after
2484  *	the station moves to associated state.
2485  * @txpwr: the station tx power configuration
2486  *
2487  */
2488 struct ieee80211_link_sta {
2489 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2490 
2491 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
2492 	u8 link_id;
2493 	enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
2494 
2495 	u32 supp_rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2496 	struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap;
2497 	struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap;
2498 	struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap;
2499 	struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa;
2500 	struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap eht_cap;
2501 	struct ieee80211_sta_uhr_cap uhr_cap;
2502 	struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap s1g_cap;
2503 
2504 	struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates agg;
2505 
2506 	u8 rx_nss;
2507 	enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth bandwidth;
2508 	struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr txpwr;
2509 };
2510 
2511 /**
2512  * struct ieee80211_sta - station table entry
2513  *
2514  * A station table entry represents a station we are possibly
2515  * communicating with. Since stations are RCU-managed in
2516  * mac80211, any ieee80211_sta pointer you get access to must
2517  * either be protected by rcu_read_lock() explicitly or implicitly,
2518  * or you must take good care to not use such a pointer after a
2519  * call to your sta_remove callback that removed it.
2520  * This also represents the MLD STA in case of MLO association
2521  * and holds pointers to various link STA's
2522  *
2523  * @addr: MAC address
2524  * @aid: AID we assigned to the station if we're an AP
2525  * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximal amount of frames in a single AMPDU
2526  *	that this station is allowed to transmit to us.
2527  *	Can be modified by driver.
2528  * @wme: indicates whether the STA supports QoS/WME (if local devices does,
2529  *	otherwise always false)
2530  * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
2531  *	sizeof(void \*), size is determined in hw information.
2532  * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Only valid
2533  *	if wme is supported. The bits order is like in
2534  *	IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_*.
2535  * @max_sp: max Service Period. Only valid if wme is supported.
2536  * @rates: rate control selection table
2537  * @tdls: indicates whether the STA is a TDLS peer
2538  * @tdls_initiator: indicates the STA is an initiator of the TDLS link. Only
2539  *	valid if the STA is a TDLS peer in the first place.
2540  * @mfp: indicates whether the STA uses management frame protection or not.
2541  * @mlo: indicates whether the STA is MLO station.
2542  * @max_amsdu_subframes: indicates the maximal number of MSDUs in a single
2543  *	A-MSDU. Taken from the Extended Capabilities element. 0 means
2544  *	unlimited.
2545  * @eml_cap: EML capabilities of this MLO station
2546  * @cur: currently valid data as aggregated from the active links
2547  *	For non MLO STA it will point to the deflink data. For MLO STA
2548  *	ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates() must be called to update it.
2549  * @support_p2p_ps: indicates whether the STA supports P2P PS mechanism or not.
2550  * @txq: per-TID data TX queues; note that the last entry (%IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS)
2551  *	is used for non-data frames
2552  * @deflink: This holds the default link STA information, for non MLO STA all link
2553  *	specific STA information is accessed through @deflink or through
2554  *	link[0] which points to address of @deflink. For MLO Link STA
2555  *	the first added link STA will point to deflink.
2556  * @link: reference to Link Sta entries. For Non MLO STA, except 1st link,
2557  *	i.e link[0] all links would be assigned to NULL by default and
2558  *	would access link information via @deflink or link[0]. For MLO
2559  *	STA, first link STA being added will point its link pointer to
2560  *	@deflink address and remaining would be allocated and the address
2561  *	would be assigned to link[link_id] where link_id is the id assigned
2562  *	by the AP.
2563  * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO
2564  * @spp_amsdu: indicates whether the STA uses SPP A-MSDU or not.
2565  * @epp_peer: indicates that the peer is an EPP peer.
2566  */
2567 struct ieee80211_sta {
2568 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2569 	u16 aid;
2570 	u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
2571 	bool wme;
2572 	u8 uapsd_queues;
2573 	u8 max_sp;
2574 	struct ieee80211_sta_rates __rcu *rates;
2575 	bool tdls;
2576 	bool tdls_initiator;
2577 	bool mfp;
2578 	bool mlo;
2579 	bool spp_amsdu;
2580 	u8 max_amsdu_subframes;
2581 	u16 eml_cap;
2582 
2583 	struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates *cur;
2584 
2585 	bool support_p2p_ps;
2586 
2587 	struct ieee80211_txq *txq[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS + 1];
2588 
2589 	u16 valid_links;
2590 	bool epp_peer;
2591 	struct ieee80211_link_sta deflink;
2592 	struct ieee80211_link_sta __rcu *link[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
2593 
2594 	/* must be last */
2595 	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2596 };
2597 
2598 #ifdef CONFIG_LOCKDEP
2599 bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
2600 #else
2601 static inline bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta)
2602 {
2603 	return true;
2604 }
2605 #endif
2606 
2607 #define link_sta_dereference_protected(sta, link_id)		\
2608 	rcu_dereference_protected((sta)->link[link_id],		\
2609 				  lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta))
2610 
2611 #define link_sta_dereference_check(sta, link_id)		\
2612 	rcu_dereference_check((sta)->link[link_id],		\
2613 			      lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta))
2614 
2615 #define for_each_sta_active_link(vif, sta, link_sta, link_id)			\
2616 	for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((sta)->link); link_id++)		\
2617 		if ((!(vif)->active_links ||					\
2618 		     (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) &&			\
2619 		    ((link_sta) = link_sta_dereference_check(sta, link_id)))
2620 
2621 /**
2622  * enum sta_notify_cmd - sta notify command
2623  *
2624  * Used with the sta_notify() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
2625  * indicates if an associated station made a power state transition.
2626  *
2627  * @STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP: a station is now sleeping
2628  * @STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE: a sleeping station woke up
2629  */
2630 enum sta_notify_cmd {
2631 	STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP, STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE,
2632 };
2633 
2634 /**
2635  * struct ieee80211_tx_control - TX control data
2636  *
2637  * @sta: station table entry, this sta pointer may be NULL and
2638  * 	it is not allowed to copy the pointer, due to RCU.
2639  */
2640 struct ieee80211_tx_control {
2641 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2642 };
2643 
2644 /**
2645  * struct ieee80211_txq - Software intermediate tx queue
2646  *
2647  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
2648  * @sta: station table entry, %NULL for per-vif queue
2649  * @tid: the TID for this queue (unused for per-vif queue),
2650  *	%IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS for non-data (if enabled)
2651  * @ac: the AC for this queue
2652  * @drv_priv: driver private area, sized by hw->txq_data_size
2653  *
2654  * The driver can obtain packets from this queue by calling
2655  * ieee80211_tx_dequeue().
2656  */
2657 struct ieee80211_txq {
2658 	struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
2659 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2660 	u8 tid;
2661 	u8 ac;
2662 
2663 	/* must be last */
2664 	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2665 };
2666 
2667 /**
2668  * enum ieee80211_hw_flags - hardware flags
2669  *
2670  * These flags are used to indicate hardware capabilities to
2671  * the stack. Generally, flags here should have their meaning
2672  * done in a way that the simplest hardware doesn't need setting
2673  * any particular flags. There are some exceptions to this rule,
2674  * however, so you are advised to review these flags carefully.
2675  *
2676  * @IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL:
2677  *	The hardware or firmware includes rate control, and cannot be
2678  *	controlled by the stack. As such, no rate control algorithm
2679  *	should be instantiated, and the TX rate reported to userspace
2680  *	will be taken from the TX status instead of the rate control
2681  *	algorithm.
2682  *	Note that this requires that the driver implement a number of
2683  *	callbacks so it has the correct information, it needs to have
2684  *	the @set_rts_threshold callback and must look at the BSS config
2685  *	@use_cts_prot for G/N protection, @use_short_slot for slot
2686  *	timing in 2.4 GHz and @use_short_preamble for preambles for
2687  *	CCK frames.
2688  *
2689  * @IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS:
2690  *	Indicates that received frames passed to the stack include
2691  *	the FCS at the end.
2692  *
2693  * @IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING:
2694  *	Some wireless LAN chipsets buffer broadcast/multicast frames
2695  *	for power saving stations in the hardware/firmware and others
2696  *	rely on the host system for such buffering. This option is used
2697  *	to configure the IEEE 802.11 upper layer to buffer broadcast and
2698  *	multicast frames when there are power saving stations so that
2699  *	the driver can fetch them with ieee80211_get_buffered_bc().
2700  *
2701  * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC:
2702  *	Hardware can provide signal values but we don't know its units. We
2703  *	expect values between 0 and @max_signal.
2704  *	If possible please provide dB or dBm instead.
2705  *
2706  * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM:
2707  *	Hardware gives signal values in dBm, decibel difference from
2708  *	one milliwatt. This is the preferred method since it is standardized
2709  *	between different devices. @max_signal does not need to be set.
2710  *
2711  * @IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT:
2712  * 	Hardware supports spectrum management defined in 802.11h
2713  * 	Measurement, Channel Switch, Quieting, TPC
2714  *
2715  * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION:
2716  *	Hardware supports 11n A-MPDU aggregation.
2717  *
2718  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS:
2719  *	Hardware has power save support (i.e. can go to sleep).
2720  *
2721  * @IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK:
2722  *	Hardware requires nullfunc frame handling in stack, implies
2723  *	stack support for dynamic PS.
2724  *
2725  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS:
2726  *	Hardware has support for dynamic PS.
2727  *
2728  * @IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE:
2729  *	Hardware supports management frame protection (MFP, IEEE 802.11w).
2730  *
2731  * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS:
2732  *	Hardware can provide ack status reports of Tx frames to
2733  *	the stack.
2734  *
2735  * @IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR:
2736  *	The hardware performs its own connection monitoring, including
2737  *	periodic keep-alives to the AP and probing the AP on beacon loss.
2738  *
2739  * @IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC:
2740  *	This device needs to get data from beacon before association (i.e.
2741  *	dtim_period).
2742  *
2743  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK: The device's crypto engine supports
2744  *	per-station GTKs as used by IBSS RSN or during fast transition. If
2745  *	the device doesn't support per-station GTKs, but can be asked not
2746  *	to decrypt group addressed frames, then IBSS RSN support is still
2747  *	possible but software crypto will be used. Advertise the wiphy flag
2748  *	only in that case.
2749  *
2750  * @IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS: When operating in AP mode the device
2751  *	autonomously manages the PS status of connected stations. When
2752  *	this flag is set mac80211 will not trigger PS mode for connected
2753  *	stations based on the PM bit of incoming frames.
2754  *	Use ieee80211_start_ps()/ieee8021_end_ps() to manually configure
2755  *	the PS mode of connected stations.
2756  *
2757  * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW: The device handles TX A-MPDU session
2758  *	setup strictly in HW. mac80211 should not attempt to do this in
2759  *	software.
2760  *
2761  * @IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF: The driver would like to be informed of
2762  *	a virtual monitor interface when monitor interfaces are the only
2763  *	active interfaces.
2764  *
2765  * @IEEE80211_HW_NO_VIRTUAL_MONITOR: The driver would like to be informed
2766  *	of any monitor interface, as well as their configured channel.
2767  *	This is useful for supporting multiple monitor interfaces on different
2768  *	channels.
2769  *
2770  * @IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF: The driver would like for no wlanX to
2771  *	be created.  It is expected user-space will create vifs as
2772  *	desired (and thus have them named as desired).
2773  *
2774  * @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL: The driver wants to control which of the
2775  *	crypto algorithms can be done in software - so don't automatically
2776  *	try to fall back to it if hardware crypto fails, but do so only if
2777  *	the driver returns 1. This also forces the driver to advertise its
2778  *	supported cipher suites.
2779  *
2780  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT: The driver/hardware supports fast-xmit,
2781  *	this currently requires only the ability to calculate the duration
2782  *	for frames.
2783  *
2784  * @IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL: The driver wants to control per-interface
2785  *	queue mapping in order to use different queues (not just one per AC)
2786  *	for different virtual interfaces. See the doc section on HW queue
2787  *	control for more details.
2788  *
2789  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE: The driver supports using a rate
2790  *	selection table provided by the rate control algorithm.
2791  *
2792  * @IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF: Use the P2P Device address for any
2793  *	P2P Interface. This will be honoured even if more than one interface
2794  *	is supported.
2795  *
2796  * @IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY: Use sync timing from beacon frames
2797  *	only, to allow getting TBTT of a DTIM beacon.
2798  *
2799  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES: Hardware supports mixing HT/CCK rates
2800  *	and can cope with CCK rates in an aggregation session (e.g. by not
2801  *	using aggregation for such frames.)
2802  *
2803  * @IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA: Support 802.11h based channel-switch (CSA)
2804  *	for a single active channel while using channel contexts. When support
2805  *	is not enabled the default action is to disconnect when getting the
2806  *	CSA frame.
2807  *
2808  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS: The driver will never modify the payload
2809  *	or tailroom of TX skbs without copying them first.
2810  *
2811  * @IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS: The HW supports scanning on all bands
2812  *	in one command, mac80211 doesn't have to run separate scans per band.
2813  *
2814  * @IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW: The device/driver supports wider bandwidth
2815  *	than then BSS bandwidth for a TDLS link on the base channel.
2816  *
2817  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU: The driver supports receiving A-MSDUs
2818  *	within A-MPDU.
2819  *
2820  * @IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS: The device/driver provides TX status
2821  *	for sent beacons.
2822  *
2823  * @IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR: Hardware (or driver) requires that each
2824  *	station has a unique address, i.e. each station entry can be identified
2825  *	by just its MAC address; this prevents, for example, the same station
2826  *	from connecting to two virtual AP interfaces at the same time.
2827  *
2828  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER: Hardware (or driver) manages the
2829  *	reordering buffer internally, guaranteeing mac80211 receives frames in
2830  *	order and does not need to manage its own reorder buffer or BA session
2831  *	timeout.
2832  *
2833  * @IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS: The device uses RSS and thus requires parallel RX,
2834  *	which implies using per-CPU station statistics.
2835  *
2836  * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU: Hardware (or driver) supports software aggregated
2837  *	A-MSDU frames. Requires software tx queueing and fast-xmit support.
2838  *	When not using minstrel/minstrel_ht rate control, the driver must
2839  *	limit the maximum A-MSDU size based on the current tx rate by setting
2840  *	max_rc_amsdu_len in struct ieee80211_sta.
2841  *
2842  * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST: Hardware (or driver) supports sending frag_list
2843  *	skbs, needed for zero-copy software A-MSDU.
2844  *
2845  * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK: The driver (or firmware) reports low ack event
2846  *	by ieee80211_report_low_ack() based on its own algorithm. For such
2847  *	drivers, mac80211 packet loss mechanism will not be triggered and driver
2848  *	is completely depending on firmware event for station kickout.
2849  *
2850  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG: Hardware does fragmentation by itself.
2851  *	The stack will not do fragmentation.
2852  *	The callback for @set_frag_threshold should be set as well.
2853  *
2854  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA: Hardware supports buffer STA on
2855  *	TDLS links.
2856  *
2857  * @IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP: The driver (or firmware) doesn't
2858  *	support QoS NDP for AP probing - that's most likely a driver bug.
2859  *
2860  * @IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ: use the TXQ for bufferable MMPDUs, this of
2861  *	course requires the driver to use TXQs to start with.
2862  *
2863  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW: (Hardware) rate control supports VHT
2864  *	extended NSS BW (dot11VHTExtendedNSSBWCapable). This flag will be set if
2865  *	the selected rate control algorithm sets %RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW
2866  *	but if the rate control is built-in then it must be set by the driver.
2867  *	See also the documentation for that flag.
2868  *
2869  * @IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ: use the extra non-TID per-station TXQ for all
2870  *	MMPDUs on station interfaces. This of course requires the driver to use
2871  *	TXQs to start with.
2872  *
2873  * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN: Driver does not report accurate A-MPDU
2874  *	length in tx status information
2875  *
2876  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
2877  *
2878  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
2879  *	only for HE APs. Applies if @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID is set.
2880  *
2881  * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT: The card and driver is only
2882  *	aggregating MPDUs with the same keyid, allowing mac80211 to keep Tx
2883  *	A-MPDU sessions active while rekeying with Extended Key ID.
2884  *
2885  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports tx encapsulation
2886  *	offload
2887  *
2888  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports rx decapsulation
2889  *	offload
2890  *
2891  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP: Hardware supports concurrent rx
2892  *	decapsulation offload and passing raw 802.11 frames for monitor iface.
2893  *	If this is supported, the driver must pass both 802.3 frames for real
2894  *	usage and 802.11 frames with %RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR set for monitor to
2895  *	the stack.
2896  *
2897  * @IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION: HW/driver has support for BSS color
2898  *	collision detection and doesn't need it in software.
2899  *
2900  * @IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX: Hardware/driver handles transmitting
2901  *	multicast frames on all links, mac80211 should not do that.
2902  *
2903  * @IEEE80211_HW_DISALLOW_PUNCTURING: HW requires disabling puncturing in EHT
2904  *	and connecting with a lower bandwidth instead
2905  *
2906  * @IEEE80211_HW_HANDLES_QUIET_CSA: HW/driver handles quieting for CSA, so
2907  *	no need to stop queues. This really should be set by a driver that
2908  *	implements MLO, so operation can continue on other links when one
2909  *	link is switching.
2910  *
2911  * @IEEE80211_HW_STRICT: strictly enforce certain things mandated by the spec
2912  *	but otherwise ignored/worked around for interoperability. This is a
2913  *	HW flag so drivers can opt in according to their own control, e.g. in
2914  *	testing.
2915  *
2916  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_NDP_BLOCKACK: HW can transmit/receive S1G NDP
2917  *	BlockAck frames.
2918  *
2919  * @NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS: number of hardware flags, used for sizing arrays
2920  */
2921 enum ieee80211_hw_flags {
2922 	IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL,
2923 	IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS,
2924 	IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING,
2925 	IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC,
2926 	IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM,
2927 	IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC,
2928 	IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT,
2929 	IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION,
2930 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS,
2931 	IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK,
2932 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS,
2933 	IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE,
2934 	IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF,
2935 	IEEE80211_HW_NO_VIRTUAL_MONITOR,
2936 	IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF,
2937 	IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL,
2938 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT,
2939 	IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS,
2940 	IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR,
2941 	IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL,
2942 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK,
2943 	IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS,
2944 	IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW,
2945 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE,
2946 	IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF,
2947 	IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY,
2948 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES,
2949 	IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA,
2950 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS,
2951 	IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS,
2952 	IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW,
2953 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU,
2954 	IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS,
2955 	IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR,
2956 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER,
2957 	IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS,
2958 	IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU,
2959 	IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST,
2960 	IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK,
2961 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG,
2962 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA,
2963 	IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP,
2964 	IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ,
2965 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW,
2966 	IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ,
2967 	IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN,
2968 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID,
2969 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID,
2970 	IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT,
2971 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD,
2972 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD,
2973 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP,
2974 	IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION,
2975 	IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX,
2976 	IEEE80211_HW_DISALLOW_PUNCTURING,
2977 	IEEE80211_HW_HANDLES_QUIET_CSA,
2978 	IEEE80211_HW_STRICT,
2979 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_NDP_BLOCKACK,
2980 
2981 	/* keep last, obviously */
2982 	NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS
2983 };
2984 
2985 /**
2986  * struct ieee80211_hw - hardware information and state
2987  *
2988  * This structure contains the configuration and hardware
2989  * information for an 802.11 PHY.
2990  *
2991  * @wiphy: This points to the &struct wiphy allocated for this
2992  *	802.11 PHY. You must fill in the @perm_addr and @dev
2993  *	members of this structure using SET_IEEE80211_DEV()
2994  *	and SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(). Additionally, all supported
2995  *	bands (with channels, bitrates) are registered here.
2996  *
2997  * @conf: &struct ieee80211_conf, device configuration, don't use.
2998  *
2999  * @priv: pointer to private area that was allocated for driver use
3000  *	along with this structure.
3001  *
3002  * @flags: hardware flags, see &enum ieee80211_hw_flags.
3003  *
3004  * @extra_tx_headroom: headroom to reserve in each transmit skb
3005  *	for use by the driver (e.g. for transmit headers.)
3006  *
3007  * @extra_beacon_tailroom: tailroom to reserve in each beacon tx skb.
3008  *	Can be used by drivers to add extra IEs.
3009  *
3010  * @max_signal: Maximum value for signal (rssi) in RX information, used
3011  *	only when @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC or @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DB
3012  *
3013  * @max_listen_interval: max listen interval in units of beacon interval
3014  *	that HW supports
3015  *
3016  * @queues: number of available hardware transmit queues for
3017  *	data packets. WMM/QoS requires at least four, these
3018  *	queues need to have configurable access parameters.
3019  *
3020  * @rate_control_algorithm: rate control algorithm for this hardware.
3021  *	If unset (NULL), the default algorithm will be used. Must be
3022  *	set before calling ieee80211_register_hw().
3023  *
3024  * @vif_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
3025  *	within &struct ieee80211_vif.
3026  * @sta_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
3027  *	within &struct ieee80211_sta.
3028  * @chanctx_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
3029  *	within &struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf.
3030  * @txq_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
3031  *	within @struct ieee80211_txq.
3032  *
3033  * @max_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages the hw
3034  *	can handle.
3035  * @max_report_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages
3036  *	the hw can report back.
3037  * @max_rate_tries: maximum number of tries for each stage
3038  *
3039  * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximum buffer size (number of
3040  *	sub-frames) to be used for A-MPDU block ack receiver
3041  *	aggregation.
3042  *	This is only relevant if the device has restrictions on the
3043  *	number of subframes, if it relies on mac80211 to do reordering
3044  *	it shouldn't be set.
3045  *
3046  * @max_tx_aggregation_subframes: maximum number of subframes in an
3047  *	aggregate an HT/HE device will transmit. In HT AddBA we'll
3048  *	advertise a constant value of 64 as some older APs crash if
3049  *	the window size is smaller (an example is LinkSys WRT120N
3050  *	with FW v1.0.07 build 002 Jun 18 2012).
3051  *	For AddBA to HE capable peers this value will be used.
3052  *
3053  * @max_tx_fragments: maximum number of tx buffers per (A)-MSDU, sum
3054  *	of 1 + skb_shinfo(skb)->nr_frags for each skb in the frag_list.
3055  *
3056  * @offchannel_tx_hw_queue: HW queue ID to use for offchannel TX
3057  *	(if %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL is set)
3058  *
3059  * @radiotap_mcs_details: lists which MCS information can the HW
3060  *	reports, by default it is set to _MCS, _GI and _BW but doesn't
3061  *	include _FMT. Use %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_\* values, only
3062  *	adding _BW is supported today.
3063  *
3064  * @radiotap_vht_details: lists which VHT MCS information the HW reports,
3065  *	the default is _GI | _BANDWIDTH.
3066  *	Use the %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_VHT_KNOWN_\* values.
3067  *
3068  * @radiotap_timestamp: Information for the radiotap timestamp field; if the
3069  *	@units_pos member is set to a non-negative value then the timestamp
3070  *	field will be added and populated from the &struct ieee80211_rx_status
3071  *	device_timestamp.
3072  * @radiotap_timestamp.units_pos: Must be set to a combination of a
3073  *	IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_UNIT_* and a
3074  *	IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_SPOS_* value.
3075  * @radiotap_timestamp.accuracy: If non-negative, fills the accuracy in the
3076  *	radiotap field and the accuracy known flag will be set.
3077  *
3078  * @netdev_features: netdev features to be set in each netdev created
3079  *	from this HW. Note that not all features are usable with mac80211,
3080  *	other features will be rejected during HW registration.
3081  *
3082  * @uapsd_queues: This bitmap is included in (re)association frame to indicate
3083  *	for each access category if it is uAPSD trigger-enabled and delivery-
3084  *	enabled. Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_* to set this bitmap.
3085  *	Each bit corresponds to different AC. Value '1' in specific bit means
3086  *	that corresponding AC is both trigger- and delivery-enabled. '0' means
3087  *	neither enabled.
3088  *
3089  * @uapsd_max_sp_len: maximum number of total buffered frames the WMM AP may
3090  *	deliver to a WMM STA during any Service Period triggered by the WMM STA.
3091  *	Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_SP_* for correct values.
3092  *
3093  * @max_nan_de_entries: maximum number of NAN DE functions supported by the
3094  *	device.
3095  *
3096  * @tx_sk_pacing_shift: Pacing shift to set on TCP sockets when frames from
3097  *	them are encountered. The default should typically not be changed,
3098  *	unless the driver has good reasons for needing more buffers.
3099  *
3100  * @weight_multiplier: Driver specific airtime weight multiplier used while
3101  *	refilling deficit of each TXQ.
3102  *
3103  * @max_mtu: the max mtu could be set.
3104  *
3105  * @tx_power_levels: a list of power levels supported by the wifi hardware.
3106  * 	The power levels can be specified either as integer or fractions.
3107  * 	The power level at idx 0 shall be the maximum positive power level.
3108  *
3109  * @max_txpwr_levels_idx: the maximum valid idx of 'tx_power_levels' list.
3110  */
3111 struct ieee80211_hw {
3112 	struct ieee80211_conf conf;
3113 	struct wiphy *wiphy;
3114 	const char *rate_control_algorithm;
3115 	void *priv;
3116 	unsigned long flags[BITS_TO_LONGS(NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS)];
3117 	unsigned int extra_tx_headroom;
3118 	unsigned int extra_beacon_tailroom;
3119 	int vif_data_size;
3120 	int sta_data_size;
3121 	int chanctx_data_size;
3122 	int txq_data_size;
3123 	u16 queues;
3124 	u16 max_listen_interval;
3125 	s8 max_signal;
3126 	u8 max_rates;
3127 	u8 max_report_rates;
3128 	u8 max_rate_tries;
3129 	u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
3130 	u16 max_tx_aggregation_subframes;
3131 	u8 max_tx_fragments;
3132 	u8 offchannel_tx_hw_queue;
3133 	u8 radiotap_mcs_details;
3134 	u16 radiotap_vht_details;
3135 	struct {
3136 		int units_pos;
3137 		s16 accuracy;
3138 	} radiotap_timestamp;
3139 	netdev_features_t netdev_features;
3140 	u8 uapsd_queues;
3141 	u8 uapsd_max_sp_len;
3142 	u8 max_nan_de_entries;
3143 	u8 tx_sk_pacing_shift;
3144 	u8 weight_multiplier;
3145 	u32 max_mtu;
3146 	const s8 *tx_power_levels;
3147 	u8 max_txpwr_levels_idx;
3148 };
3149 
3150 static inline bool _ieee80211_hw_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3151 				       enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
3152 {
3153 	return test_bit(flg, hw->flags);
3154 }
3155 #define ieee80211_hw_check(hw, flg)	_ieee80211_hw_check(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
3156 
3157 static inline void _ieee80211_hw_set(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3158 				     enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
3159 {
3160 	return __set_bit(flg, hw->flags);
3161 }
3162 #define ieee80211_hw_set(hw, flg)	_ieee80211_hw_set(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
3163 
3164 /**
3165  * struct ieee80211_scan_request - hw scan request
3166  *
3167  * @ies: pointers different parts of IEs (in req.ie)
3168  * @req: cfg80211 request.
3169  */
3170 struct ieee80211_scan_request {
3171 	struct ieee80211_scan_ies ies;
3172 
3173 	/* Keep last */
3174 	struct cfg80211_scan_request req;
3175 };
3176 
3177 /**
3178  * struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params - TDLS channel switch parameters
3179  *
3180  * @sta: peer this TDLS channel-switch request/response came from
3181  * @chandef: channel referenced in a TDLS channel-switch request
3182  * @action_code: see &enum ieee80211_tdls_actioncode
3183  * @status: channel-switch response status
3184  * @timestamp: time at which the frame was received
3185  * @switch_time: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
3186  * @switch_timeout: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
3187  * @tmpl_skb: TDLS switch-channel response template
3188  * @ch_sw_tm_ie: offset of the channel-switch timing IE inside @tmpl_skb
3189  */
3190 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params {
3191 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
3192 	struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef;
3193 	u8 action_code;
3194 	u32 status;
3195 	u32 timestamp;
3196 	u16 switch_time;
3197 	u16 switch_timeout;
3198 	struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb;
3199 	u32 ch_sw_tm_ie;
3200 };
3201 
3202 /**
3203  * wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw - return a mac80211 driver hw struct from a wiphy
3204  *
3205  * @wiphy: the &struct wiphy which we want to query
3206  *
3207  * mac80211 drivers can use this to get to their respective
3208  * &struct ieee80211_hw. Drivers wishing to get to their own private
3209  * structure can then access it via hw->priv. Note that mac802111 drivers should
3210  * not use wiphy_priv() to try to get their private driver structure as this
3211  * is already used internally by mac80211.
3212  *
3213  * Return: The mac80211 driver hw struct of @wiphy.
3214  */
3215 struct ieee80211_hw *wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw(struct wiphy *wiphy);
3216 
3217 /**
3218  * SET_IEEE80211_DEV - set device for 802.11 hardware
3219  *
3220  * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the device for
3221  * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
3222  */
3223 static inline void SET_IEEE80211_DEV(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct device *dev)
3224 {
3225 	set_wiphy_dev(hw->wiphy, dev);
3226 }
3227 
3228 /**
3229  * SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR - set the permanent MAC address for 802.11 hardware
3230  *
3231  * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the MAC address for
3232  * @addr: the address to set
3233  */
3234 static inline void SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, const u8 *addr)
3235 {
3236 	memcpy(hw->wiphy->perm_addr, addr, ETH_ALEN);
3237 }
3238 
3239 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
3240 ieee80211_get_tx_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3241 		      const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
3242 {
3243 	if (WARN_ON_ONCE(c->control.rates[0].idx < 0))
3244 		return NULL;
3245 
3246 	if (c->band >= NUM_NL80211_BANDS)
3247 		return NULL;
3248 
3249 	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[0].idx];
3250 }
3251 
3252 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
3253 ieee80211_get_rts_cts_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3254 			   const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
3255 {
3256 	if (c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx < 0)
3257 		return NULL;
3258 	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx];
3259 }
3260 
3261 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
3262 ieee80211_get_alt_retry_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3263 			     const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c, int idx)
3264 {
3265 	if (c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx < 0)
3266 		return NULL;
3267 	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx];
3268 }
3269 
3270 /**
3271  * ieee80211_free_txskb - free TX skb
3272  * @hw: the hardware
3273  * @skb: the skb
3274  *
3275  * Free a transmit skb. Use this function when some failure
3276  * to transmit happened and thus status cannot be reported.
3277  */
3278 void ieee80211_free_txskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
3279 
3280 /**
3281  * ieee80211_purge_tx_queue - purge TX skb queue
3282  * @hw: the hardware
3283  * @skbs: the skbs
3284  *
3285  * Free a set of transmit skbs. Use this function when device is going to stop
3286  * but some transmit skbs without TX status are still queued.
3287  * This function does not take the list lock and the caller must hold the
3288  * relevant locks to use it.
3289  */
3290 void ieee80211_purge_tx_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3291 			      struct sk_buff_head *skbs);
3292 
3293 /**
3294  * DOC: Hardware crypto acceleration
3295  *
3296  * mac80211 is capable of taking advantage of many hardware
3297  * acceleration designs for encryption and decryption operations.
3298  *
3299  * The set_key() callback in the &struct ieee80211_ops for a given
3300  * device is called to enable hardware acceleration of encryption and
3301  * decryption. The callback takes a @sta parameter that will be NULL
3302  * for default keys or keys used for transmission only, or point to
3303  * the station information for the peer for individual keys.
3304  * Multiple transmission keys with the same key index may be used when
3305  * VLANs are configured for an access point.
3306  *
3307  * When transmitting, the TX control data will use the @hw_key_idx
3308  * selected by the driver by modifying the &struct ieee80211_key_conf
3309  * pointed to by the @key parameter to the set_key() function.
3310  *
3311  * The set_key() call for the %SET_KEY command should return 0 if
3312  * the key is now in use, -%EOPNOTSUPP or -%ENOSPC if it couldn't be
3313  * added; if you return 0 then hw_key_idx must be assigned to the
3314  * hardware key index. You are free to use the full u8 range.
3315  *
3316  * Note that in the case that the @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL flag is
3317  * set, mac80211 will not automatically fall back to software crypto if
3318  * enabling hardware crypto failed. The set_key() call may also return the
3319  * value 1 to permit this specific key/algorithm to be done in software.
3320  *
3321  * When the cmd is %DISABLE_KEY then it must succeed.
3322  *
3323  * Note that it is permissible to not decrypt a frame even if a key
3324  * for it has been uploaded to hardware. The stack will not make any
3325  * decision based on whether a key has been uploaded or not but rather
3326  * based on the receive flags.
3327  *
3328  * The &struct ieee80211_key_conf structure pointed to by the @key
3329  * parameter is guaranteed to be valid until another call to set_key()
3330  * removes it, but it can only be used as a cookie to differentiate
3331  * keys.
3332  *
3333  * In TKIP some HW need to be provided a phase 1 key, for RX decryption
3334  * acceleration (i.e. iwlwifi). Those drivers should provide update_tkip_key
3335  * handler.
3336  * The update_tkip_key() call updates the driver with the new phase 1 key.
3337  * This happens every time the iv16 wraps around (every 65536 packets). The
3338  * set_key() call will happen only once for each key (unless the AP did
3339  * rekeying); it will not include a valid phase 1 key. The valid phase 1 key is
3340  * provided by update_tkip_key only. The trigger that makes mac80211 call this
3341  * handler is software decryption with wrap around of iv16.
3342  *
3343  * The set_default_unicast_key() call updates the default WEP key index
3344  * configured to the hardware for WEP encryption type. This is required
3345  * for devices that support offload of data packets (e.g. ARP responses).
3346  *
3347  * Mac80211 drivers should set the @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0 flag
3348  * when they are able to replace in-use PTK keys according to the following
3349  * requirements:
3350  * 1) They do not hand over frames decrypted with the old key to mac80211
3351       once the call to set_key() with command %DISABLE_KEY has been completed,
3352    2) either drop or continue to use the old key for any outgoing frames queued
3353       at the time of the key deletion (including re-transmits),
3354    3) never send out a frame queued prior to the set_key() %SET_KEY command
3355       encrypted with the new key when also needing
3356       @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV and
3357    4) never send out a frame unencrypted when it should be encrypted.
3358    Mac80211 will not queue any new frames for a deleted key to the driver.
3359  */
3360 
3361 /**
3362  * DOC: Powersave support
3363  *
3364  * mac80211 has support for various powersave implementations.
3365  *
3366  * First, it can support hardware that handles all powersaving by itself;
3367  * such hardware should simply set the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS hardware
3368  * flag. In that case, it will be told about the desired powersave mode
3369  * with the %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag depending on the association status.
3370  * The hardware must take care of sending nullfunc frames when necessary,
3371  * i.e. when entering and leaving powersave mode. The hardware is required
3372  * to look at the AID in beacons and signal to the AP that it woke up when
3373  * it finds traffic directed to it.
3374  *
3375  * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag enabled means that the powersave mode defined in
3376  * IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2 is enabled. This is not to be confused
3377  * with hardware wakeup and sleep states. Driver is responsible for waking
3378  * up the hardware before issuing commands to the hardware and putting it
3379  * back to sleep at appropriate times.
3380  *
3381  * When PS is enabled, hardware needs to wakeup for beacons and receive the
3382  * buffered multicast/broadcast frames after the beacon. Also it must be
3383  * possible to send frames and receive the acknowledment frame.
3384  *
3385  * Other hardware designs cannot send nullfunc frames by themselves and also
3386  * need software support for parsing the TIM bitmap. This is also supported
3387  * by mac80211 by combining the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS and
3388  * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK flags. The hardware is of course still
3389  * required to pass up beacons. The hardware is still required to handle
3390  * waking up for multicast traffic; if it cannot the driver must handle that
3391  * as best as it can; mac80211 is too slow to do that.
3392  *
3393  * Dynamic powersave is an extension to normal powersave in which the
3394  * hardware stays awake for a user-specified period of time after sending a
3395  * frame so that reply frames need not be buffered and therefore delayed to
3396  * the next wakeup. It's a compromise of getting good enough latency when
3397  * there's data traffic and still saving significantly power in idle
3398  * periods.
3399  *
3400  * Dynamic powersave is simply supported by mac80211 enabling and disabling
3401  * PS based on traffic. Driver needs to only set %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS
3402  * flag and mac80211 will handle everything automatically. Additionally,
3403  * hardware having support for the dynamic PS feature may set the
3404  * %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS flag to indicate that it can support
3405  * dynamic PS mode itself. The driver needs to look at the
3406  * @dynamic_ps_timeout hardware configuration value and use it that value
3407  * whenever %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. In this case mac80211 will disable
3408  * dynamic PS feature in stack and will just keep %IEEE80211_CONF_PS
3409  * enabled whenever user has enabled powersave.
3410  *
3411  * Driver informs U-APSD client support by enabling
3412  * %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD flag. The mode is configured through the
3413  * uapsd parameter in conf_tx() operation. Hardware needs to send the QoS
3414  * Nullfunc frames and stay awake until the service period has ended. To
3415  * utilize U-APSD, dynamic powersave is disabled for voip AC and all frames
3416  * from that AC are transmitted with powersave enabled.
3417  *
3418  * Note: U-APSD client mode is not yet supported with
3419  * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK.
3420  */
3421 
3422 /**
3423  * DOC: Beacon filter support
3424  *
3425  * Some hardware have beacon filter support to reduce host cpu wakeups
3426  * which will reduce system power consumption. It usually works so that
3427  * the firmware creates a checksum of the beacon but omits all constantly
3428  * changing elements (TSF, TIM etc). Whenever the checksum changes the
3429  * beacon is forwarded to the host, otherwise it will be just dropped. That
3430  * way the host will only receive beacons where some relevant information
3431  * (for example ERP protection or WMM settings) have changed.
3432  *
3433  * Beacon filter support is advertised with the %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER
3434  * interface capability. The driver needs to enable beacon filter support
3435  * whenever power save is enabled, that is %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. When
3436  * power save is enabled, the stack will not check for beacon loss and the
3437  * driver needs to notify about loss of beacons with ieee80211_beacon_loss().
3438  *
3439  * The time (or number of beacons missed) until the firmware notifies the
3440  * driver of a beacon loss event (which in turn causes the driver to call
3441  * ieee80211_beacon_loss()) should be configurable and will be controlled
3442  * by mac80211 and the roaming algorithm in the future.
3443  *
3444  * Since there may be constantly changing information elements that nothing
3445  * in the software stack cares about, we will, in the future, have mac80211
3446  * tell the driver which information elements are interesting in the sense
3447  * that we want to see changes in them. This will include
3448  *
3449  *  - a list of information element IDs
3450  *  - a list of OUIs for the vendor information element
3451  *
3452  * Ideally, the hardware would filter out any beacons without changes in the
3453  * requested elements, but if it cannot support that it may, at the expense
3454  * of some efficiency, filter out only a subset. For example, if the device
3455  * doesn't support checking for OUIs it should pass up all changes in all
3456  * vendor information elements.
3457  *
3458  * Note that change, for the sake of simplification, also includes information
3459  * elements appearing or disappearing from the beacon.
3460  *
3461  * Some hardware supports an "ignore list" instead. Just make sure nothing
3462  * that was requested is on the ignore list, and include commonly changing
3463  * information element IDs in the ignore list, for example 11 (BSS load) and
3464  * the various vendor-assigned IEs with unknown contents (128, 129, 133-136,
3465  * 149, 150, 155, 156, 173, 176, 178, 179, 219); for forward compatibility
3466  * it could also include some currently unused IDs.
3467  *
3468  *
3469  * In addition to these capabilities, hardware should support notifying the
3470  * host of changes in the beacon RSSI. This is relevant to implement roaming
3471  * when no traffic is flowing (when traffic is flowing we see the RSSI of
3472  * the received data packets). This can consist of notifying the host when
3473  * the RSSI changes significantly or when it drops below or rises above
3474  * configurable thresholds. In the future these thresholds will also be
3475  * configured by mac80211 (which gets them from userspace) to implement
3476  * them as the roaming algorithm requires.
3477  *
3478  * If the hardware cannot implement this, the driver should ask it to
3479  * periodically pass beacon frames to the host so that software can do the
3480  * signal strength threshold checking.
3481  */
3482 
3483 /**
3484  * DOC: Spatial multiplexing power save
3485  *
3486  * SMPS (Spatial multiplexing power save) is a mechanism to conserve
3487  * power in an 802.11n implementation. For details on the mechanism
3488  * and rationale, please refer to 802.11 (as amended by 802.11n-2009)
3489  * "11.2.3 SM power save".
3490  *
3491  * The mac80211 implementation is capable of sending action frames
3492  * to update the AP about the station's SMPS mode, and will instruct
3493  * the driver to enter the specific mode. It will also announce the
3494  * requested SMPS mode during the association handshake. Hardware
3495  * support for this feature is required, and can be indicated by
3496  * hardware flags.
3497  *
3498  * The default mode will be "automatic", which nl80211/cfg80211
3499  * defines to be dynamic SMPS in (regular) powersave, and SMPS
3500  * turned off otherwise.
3501  *
3502  * To support this feature, the driver must set the appropriate
3503  * hardware support flags, and handle the SMPS flag to the config()
3504  * operation. It will then with this mechanism be instructed to
3505  * enter the requested SMPS mode while associated to an HT AP.
3506  */
3507 
3508 /**
3509  * DOC: Frame filtering
3510  *
3511  * mac80211 requires to see many management frames for proper
3512  * operation, and users may want to see many more frames when
3513  * in monitor mode. However, for best CPU usage and power consumption,
3514  * having as few frames as possible percolate through the stack is
3515  * desirable. Hence, the hardware should filter as much as possible.
3516  *
3517  * To achieve this, mac80211 uses filter flags (see below) to tell
3518  * the driver's configure_filter() function which frames should be
3519  * passed to mac80211 and which should be filtered out.
3520  *
3521  * Before configure_filter() is invoked, the prepare_multicast()
3522  * callback is invoked with the parameters @mc_count and @mc_list
3523  * for the combined multicast address list of all virtual interfaces.
3524  * It's use is optional, and it returns a u64 that is passed to
3525  * configure_filter(). Additionally, configure_filter() has the
3526  * arguments @changed_flags telling which flags were changed and
3527  * @total_flags with the new flag states.
3528  *
3529  * If your device has no multicast address filters your driver will
3530  * need to check both the %FIF_ALLMULTI flag and the @mc_count
3531  * parameter to see whether multicast frames should be accepted
3532  * or dropped.
3533  *
3534  * All unsupported flags in @total_flags must be cleared.
3535  * Hardware does not support a flag if it is incapable of _passing_
3536  * the frame to the stack. Otherwise the driver must ignore
3537  * the flag, but not clear it.
3538  * You must _only_ clear the flag (announce no support for the
3539  * flag to mac80211) if you are not able to pass the packet type
3540  * to the stack (so the hardware always filters it).
3541  * So for example, you should clear @FIF_CONTROL, if your hardware
3542  * always filters control frames. If your hardware always passes
3543  * control frames to the kernel and is incapable of filtering them,
3544  * you do _not_ clear the @FIF_CONTROL flag.
3545  * This rule applies to all other FIF flags as well.
3546  */
3547 
3548 /**
3549  * DOC: AP support for powersaving clients
3550  *
3551  * In order to implement AP and P2P GO modes, mac80211 has support for
3552  * client powersaving, both "legacy" PS (PS-Poll/null data) and uAPSD.
3553  * There currently is no support for sAPSD.
3554  *
3555  * There is one assumption that mac80211 makes, namely that a client
3556  * will not poll with PS-Poll and trigger with uAPSD at the same time.
3557  * Both are supported, and both can be used by the same client, but
3558  * they can't be used concurrently by the same client. This simplifies
3559  * the driver code.
3560  *
3561  * The first thing to keep in mind is that there is a flag for complete
3562  * driver implementation: %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS. If this flag is set,
3563  * mac80211 expects the driver to handle most of the state machine for
3564  * powersaving clients and will ignore the PM bit in incoming frames.
3565  * Drivers then use ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() to inform mac80211 of
3566  * stations' powersave transitions. In this mode, mac80211 also doesn't
3567  * handle PS-Poll/uAPSD.
3568  *
3569  * In the mode without %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS, mac80211 will check the
3570  * PM bit in incoming frames for client powersave transitions. When a
3571  * station goes to sleep, we will stop transmitting to it. There is,
3572  * however, a race condition: a station might go to sleep while there is
3573  * data buffered on hardware queues. If the device has support for this
3574  * it will reject frames, and the driver should give the frames back to
3575  * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED flag set which will
3576  * cause mac80211 to retry the frame when the station wakes up. The
3577  * driver is also notified of powersave transitions by calling its
3578  * @sta_notify callback.
3579  *
3580  * When the station is asleep, it has three choices: it can wake up,
3581  * it can PS-Poll, or it can possibly start a uAPSD service period.
3582  * Waking up is implemented by simply transmitting all buffered (and
3583  * filtered) frames to the station. This is the easiest case. When
3584  * the station sends a PS-Poll or a uAPSD trigger frame, mac80211
3585  * will inform the driver of this with the @allow_buffered_frames
3586  * callback; this callback is optional. mac80211 will then transmit
3587  * the frames as usual and set the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER
3588  * on each frame. The last frame in the service period (or the only
3589  * response to a PS-Poll) also has %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set to
3590  * indicate that it ends the service period; as this frame must have
3591  * TX status report it also sets %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS.
3592  * When TX status is reported for this frame, the service period is
3593  * marked has having ended and a new one can be started by the peer.
3594  *
3595  * Additionally, non-bufferable MMPDUs can also be transmitted by
3596  * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER set in them.
3597  *
3598  * Another race condition can happen on some devices like iwlwifi
3599  * when there are frames queued for the station and it wakes up
3600  * or polls; the frames that are already queued could end up being
3601  * transmitted first instead, causing reordering and/or wrong
3602  * processing of the EOSP. The cause is that allowing frames to be
3603  * transmitted to a certain station is out-of-band communication to
3604  * the device. To allow this problem to be solved, the driver can
3605  * call ieee80211_sta_block_awake() if frames are buffered when it
3606  * is notified that the station went to sleep. When all these frames
3607  * have been filtered (see above), it must call the function again
3608  * to indicate that the station is no longer blocked.
3609  *
3610  * If the driver buffers frames in the driver for aggregation in any
3611  * way, it must use the ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() call when it is
3612  * notified of the station going to sleep to inform mac80211 of any
3613  * TIDs that have frames buffered. Note that when a station wakes up
3614  * this information is reset (hence the requirement to call it when
3615  * informed of the station going to sleep). Then, when a service
3616  * period starts for any reason, @release_buffered_frames is called
3617  * with the number of frames to be released and which TIDs they are
3618  * to come from. In this case, the driver is responsible for setting
3619  * the EOSP (for uAPSD) and MORE_DATA bits in the released frames.
3620  * To help the @more_data parameter is passed to tell the driver if
3621  * there is more data on other TIDs -- the TIDs to release frames
3622  * from are ignored since mac80211 doesn't know how many frames the
3623  * buffers for those TIDs contain.
3624  *
3625  * If the driver also implement GO mode, where absence periods may
3626  * shorten service periods (or abort PS-Poll responses), it must
3627  * filter those response frames except in the case of frames that
3628  * are buffered in the driver -- those must remain buffered to avoid
3629  * reordering. Because it is possible that no frames are released
3630  * in this case, the driver must call ieee80211_sta_eosp()
3631  * to indicate to mac80211 that the service period ended anyway.
3632  *
3633  * Finally, if frames from multiple TIDs are released from mac80211
3634  * but the driver might reorder them, it must clear & set the flags
3635  * appropriately (only the last frame may have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
3636  * and also take care of the EOSP and MORE_DATA bits in the frame.
3637  * The driver may also use ieee80211_sta_eosp() in this case.
3638  *
3639  * Note that if the driver ever buffers frames other than QoS-data
3640  * frames, it must take care to never send a non-QoS-data frame as
3641  * the last frame in a service period, adding a QoS-nulldata frame
3642  * after a non-QoS-data frame if needed.
3643  */
3644 
3645 /**
3646  * DOC: HW queue control
3647  *
3648  * Before HW queue control was introduced, mac80211 only had a single static
3649  * assignment of per-interface AC software queues to hardware queues. This
3650  * was problematic for a few reasons:
3651  * 1) off-channel transmissions might get stuck behind other frames
3652  * 2) multiple virtual interfaces couldn't be handled correctly
3653  * 3) after-DTIM frames could get stuck behind other frames
3654  *
3655  * To solve this, hardware typically uses multiple different queues for all
3656  * the different usages, and this needs to be propagated into mac80211 so it
3657  * won't have the same problem with the software queues.
3658  *
3659  * Therefore, mac80211 now offers the %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL capability
3660  * flag that tells it that the driver implements its own queue control. To do
3661  * so, the driver will set up the various queues in each &struct ieee80211_vif
3662  * and the offchannel queue in &struct ieee80211_hw. In response, mac80211 will
3663  * use those queue IDs in the hw_queue field of &struct ieee80211_tx_info and
3664  * if necessary will queue the frame on the right software queue that mirrors
3665  * the hardware queue.
3666  * Additionally, the driver has to then use these HW queue IDs for the queue
3667  * management functions (ieee80211_stop_queue() et al.)
3668  *
3669  * The driver is free to set up the queue mappings as needed; multiple virtual
3670  * interfaces may map to the same hardware queues if needed. The setup has to
3671  * happen during add_interface or change_interface callbacks. For example, a
3672  * driver supporting station+station and station+AP modes might decide to have
3673  * 10 hardware queues to handle different scenarios:
3674  *
3675  * 4 AC HW queues for 1st vif: 0, 1, 2, 3
3676  * 4 AC HW queues for 2nd vif: 4, 5, 6, 7
3677  * after-DTIM queue for AP:   8
3678  * off-channel queue:         9
3679  *
3680  * It would then set up the hardware like this:
3681  *   hw.offchannel_tx_hw_queue = 9
3682  *
3683  * and the first virtual interface that is added as follows:
3684  *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VO] = 0
3685  *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VI] = 1
3686  *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BE] = 2
3687  *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BK] = 3
3688  *   vif.cab_queue = 8 // if AP mode, otherwise %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
3689  * and the second virtual interface with 4-7.
3690  *
3691  * If queue 6 gets full, for example, mac80211 would only stop the second
3692  * virtual interface's BE queue since virtual interface queues are per AC.
3693  *
3694  * Note that the vif.cab_queue value should be set to %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
3695  * whenever the queue is not used (i.e. the interface is not in AP mode) if the
3696  * queue could potentially be shared since mac80211 will look at cab_queue when
3697  * a queue is stopped/woken even if the interface is not in AP mode.
3698  */
3699 
3700 /**
3701  * enum ieee80211_filter_flags - hardware filter flags
3702  *
3703  * These flags determine what the filter in hardware should be
3704  * programmed to let through and what should not be passed to the
3705  * stack. It is always safe to pass more frames than requested,
3706  * but this has negative impact on power consumption.
3707  *
3708  * @FIF_ALLMULTI: pass all multicast frames, this is used if requested
3709  *	by the user or if the hardware is not capable of filtering by
3710  *	multicast address.
3711  *
3712  * @FIF_FCSFAIL: pass frames with failed FCS (but you need to set the
3713  *	%RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC for them)
3714  *
3715  * @FIF_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with failed PLCP CRC (but you need to set
3716  *	the %RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC for them
3717  *
3718  * @FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC: This flag is set during scanning to indicate
3719  *	to the hardware that it should not filter beacons or probe responses
3720  *	by BSSID. Filtering them can greatly reduce the amount of processing
3721  *	mac80211 needs to do and the amount of CPU wakeups, so you should
3722  *	honour this flag if possible.
3723  *
3724  * @FIF_CONTROL: pass control frames (except for PS Poll) addressed to this
3725  *	station
3726  *
3727  * @FIF_OTHER_BSS: pass frames destined to other BSSes
3728  *
3729  * @FIF_PSPOLL: pass PS Poll frames
3730  *
3731  * @FIF_PROBE_REQ: pass probe request frames
3732  *
3733  * @FIF_MCAST_ACTION: pass multicast Action frames
3734  */
3735 enum ieee80211_filter_flags {
3736 	FIF_ALLMULTI		= 1<<1,
3737 	FIF_FCSFAIL		= 1<<2,
3738 	FIF_PLCPFAIL		= 1<<3,
3739 	FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC	= 1<<4,
3740 	FIF_CONTROL		= 1<<5,
3741 	FIF_OTHER_BSS		= 1<<6,
3742 	FIF_PSPOLL		= 1<<7,
3743 	FIF_PROBE_REQ		= 1<<8,
3744 	FIF_MCAST_ACTION	= 1<<9,
3745 };
3746 
3747 /**
3748  * enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action - A-MPDU actions
3749  *
3750  * These flags are used with the ampdu_action() callback in
3751  * &struct ieee80211_ops to indicate which action is needed.
3752  *
3753  * Note that drivers MUST be able to deal with a TX aggregation
3754  * session being stopped even before they OK'ed starting it by
3755  * calling ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe, because the peer
3756  * might receive the addBA frame and send a delBA right away!
3757  *
3758  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START: start RX aggregation
3759  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP: stop RX aggregation
3760  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START: start TX aggregation, the driver must either
3761  *	call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() or
3762  *	call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() with status
3763  *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA to delay addba after
3764  *	ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe is called, or just return the special
3765  *	status %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE.
3766  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL: TX aggregation has become operational
3767  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT: stop TX aggregation but continue transmitting
3768  *	queued packets, now unaggregated. After all packets are transmitted the
3769  *	driver has to call ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe().
3770  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH: stop TX aggregation and flush all packets,
3771  *	called when the station is removed. There's no need or reason to call
3772  *	ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() in this case as mac80211 assumes the
3773  *	session is gone and removes the station.
3774  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT: called when TX aggregation is stopped
3775  *	but the driver hasn't called ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() yet and
3776  *	now the connection is dropped and the station will be removed. Drivers
3777  *	should clean up and drop remaining packets when this is called.
3778  */
3779 enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action {
3780 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START,
3781 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP,
3782 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START,
3783 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT,
3784 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH,
3785 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT,
3786 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL,
3787 };
3788 
3789 #define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE 1
3790 #define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA 2
3791 
3792 /**
3793  * struct ieee80211_ampdu_params - AMPDU action parameters
3794  *
3795  * @action: the ampdu action, value from %ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
3796  * @sta: peer of this AMPDU session
3797  * @tid: tid of the BA session
3798  * @ssn: start sequence number of the session. TX/RX_STOP can pass 0. When
3799  *	action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START the driver passes back the
3800  *	actual ssn value used to start the session and writes the value here.
3801  * @buf_size: reorder buffer size  (number of subframes). Valid only when the
3802  *	action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START or
3803  *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
3804  * @amsdu: indicates the peer's ability to receive A-MSDU within A-MPDU.
3805  *	valid when the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
3806  * @timeout: BA session timeout. Valid only when the action is set to
3807  *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START
3808  */
3809 struct ieee80211_ampdu_params {
3810 	enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action action;
3811 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
3812 	u16 tid;
3813 	u16 ssn;
3814 	u16 buf_size;
3815 	bool amsdu;
3816 	u16 timeout;
3817 };
3818 
3819 /**
3820  * enum ieee80211_frame_release_type - frame release reason
3821  * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL: frame released for PS-Poll
3822  * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD: frame(s) released due to
3823  *	frame received on trigger-enabled AC
3824  */
3825 enum ieee80211_frame_release_type {
3826 	IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL,
3827 	IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD,
3828 };
3829 
3830 /**
3831  * enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed - flags to indicate what changed
3832  *
3833  * @IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED: The bandwidth that can be used to transmit
3834  *	to this station changed. The actual bandwidth is in the station
3835  *	information -- for HT20/40 the IEEE80211_HT_CAP_SUP_WIDTH_20_40
3836  *	flag changes, for HT and VHT the bandwidth field changes.
3837  * @IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED: The SMPS state of the station changed.
3838  * @IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED: The supported rate set of this peer
3839  *	changed (in IBSS mode) due to discovering more information about
3840  *	the peer.
3841  * @IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED: N_SS (number of spatial streams) was changed
3842  *	by the peer
3843  */
3844 enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed {
3845 	IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED		= BIT(0),
3846 	IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED	= BIT(1),
3847 	IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED	= BIT(2),
3848 	IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED	= BIT(3),
3849 };
3850 
3851 /**
3852  * enum ieee80211_roc_type - remain on channel type
3853  *
3854  * With the support for multi channel contexts and multi channel operations,
3855  * remain on channel operations might be limited/deferred/aborted by other
3856  * flows/operations which have higher priority (and vice versa).
3857  * Specifying the ROC type can be used by devices to prioritize the ROC
3858  * operations compared to other operations/flows.
3859  *
3860  * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL: There are no special requirements for this ROC.
3861  * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX: The remain on channel request is required
3862  *	for sending management frames offchannel.
3863  */
3864 enum ieee80211_roc_type {
3865 	IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL = 0,
3866 	IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX,
3867 };
3868 
3869 /**
3870  * enum ieee80211_reconfig_type - reconfig type
3871  *
3872  * This enum is used by the reconfig_complete() callback to indicate what
3873  * reconfiguration type was completed.
3874  *
3875  * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART: hw restart type
3876  *	(also due to resume() callback returning 1)
3877  * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND: suspend type (regardless
3878  *	of wowlan configuration)
3879  */
3880 enum ieee80211_reconfig_type {
3881 	IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART,
3882 	IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND,
3883 };
3884 
3885 /**
3886  * struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info - prepare TX information
3887  * @duration: if non-zero, hint about the required duration,
3888  *	only used with the mgd_prepare_tx() method.
3889  * @subtype: frame subtype (auth, (re)assoc, deauth, disassoc)
3890  * @success: whether the frame exchange was successful, only
3891  *	used with the mgd_complete_tx() method, and then only
3892  *	valid for auth and (re)assoc.
3893  * @was_assoc: set if this call is due to deauth/disassoc
3894  *	while just having been associated
3895  * @link_id: the link id on which the frame will be TX'ed.
3896  *	0 for a non-MLO connection.
3897  */
3898 struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info {
3899 	u16 duration;
3900 	u16 subtype;
3901 	u8 success:1, was_assoc:1;
3902 	int link_id;
3903 };
3904 
3905 /**
3906  * struct ieee80211_ops - callbacks from mac80211 to the driver
3907  *
3908  * This structure contains various callbacks that the driver may
3909  * handle or, in some cases, must handle, for example to configure
3910  * the hardware to a new channel or to transmit a frame.
3911  *
3912  * @tx: Handler that 802.11 module calls for each transmitted frame.
3913  *	skb contains the buffer starting from the IEEE 802.11 header.
3914  *	The low-level driver should send the frame out based on
3915  *	configuration in the TX control data. This handler should,
3916  *	preferably, never fail and stop queues appropriately.
3917  *	Must be atomic.
3918  *
3919  * @start: Called before the first netdevice attached to the hardware
3920  *	is enabled. This should turn on the hardware and must turn on
3921  *	frame reception (for possibly enabled monitor interfaces.)
3922  *	Returns negative error codes, these may be seen in userspace,
3923  *	or zero.
3924  *	When the device is started it should not have a MAC address
3925  *	to avoid acknowledging frames before a non-monitor device
3926  *	is added.
3927  *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3928  *
3929  * @stop: Called after last netdevice attached to the hardware
3930  *	is disabled. This should turn off the hardware (at least
3931  *	it must turn off frame reception.)
3932  *	May be called right after add_interface if that rejects
3933  *	an interface. If you added any work onto the mac80211 workqueue
3934  *	you should ensure to cancel it on this callback.
3935  *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3936  *
3937  * @suspend: Suspend the device; mac80211 itself will quiesce before and
3938  *	stop transmitting and doing any other configuration, and then
3939  *	ask the device to suspend. This is only invoked when WoWLAN is
3940  *	configured, otherwise the device is deconfigured completely and
3941  *	reconfigured at resume time.
3942  *	The driver may also impose special conditions under which it
3943  *	wants to use the "normal" suspend (deconfigure), say if it only
3944  *	supports WoWLAN when the device is associated. In this case, it
3945  *	must return 1 from this function.
3946  *
3947  * @resume: If WoWLAN was configured, this indicates that mac80211 is
3948  *	now resuming its operation, after this the device must be fully
3949  *	functional again. If this returns an error, the only way out is
3950  *	to also unregister the device. If it returns 1, then mac80211
3951  *	will also go through the regular complete restart on resume.
3952  *
3953  * @set_wakeup: Enable or disable wakeup when WoWLAN configuration is
3954  *	modified. The reason is that device_set_wakeup_enable() is
3955  *	supposed to be called when the configuration changes, not only
3956  *	in suspend().
3957  *
3958  * @add_interface: Called when a netdevice attached to the hardware is
3959  *	enabled. Because it is not called for monitor mode devices, @start
3960  *	and @stop must be implemented.
3961  *	The driver should perform any initialization it needs before
3962  *	the device can be enabled. The initial configuration for the
3963  *	interface is given in the conf parameter.
3964  *	The callback may refuse to add an interface by returning a
3965  *	negative error code (which will be seen in userspace.)
3966  *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3967  *
3968  * @change_interface: Called when a netdevice changes type. This callback
3969  *	is optional, but only if it is supported can interface types be
3970  *	switched while the interface is UP. The callback may sleep.
3971  *	Note that while an interface is being switched, it will not be
3972  *	found by the interface iteration callbacks.
3973  *
3974  * @remove_interface: Notifies a driver that an interface is going down.
3975  *	The @stop callback is called after this if it is the last interface
3976  *	and no monitor interfaces are present.
3977  *	When all interfaces are removed, the MAC address in the hardware
3978  *	must be cleared so the device no longer acknowledges packets,
3979  *	the mac_addr member of the conf structure is, however, set to the
3980  *	MAC address of the device going away.
3981  *	Hence, this callback must be implemented. It can sleep.
3982  *
3983  * @config: Handler for configuration requests. IEEE 802.11 code calls this
3984  *	function to change hardware configuration, e.g., channel.
3985  *	This function should never fail but returns a negative error code
3986  *	if it does. The callback can sleep.
3987  *
3988  * @bss_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to BSS
3989  *	parameters that may vary during BSS's lifespan, and may affect low
3990  *	level driver (e.g. assoc/disassoc status, erp parameters).
3991  *	This function should not be used if no BSS has been set, unless
3992  *	for association indication. The @changed parameter indicates which
3993  *	of the bss parameters has changed when a call is made. The callback
3994  *	can sleep.
3995  *	Note: this callback is called if @vif_cfg_changed or @link_info_changed
3996  *	are not implemented.
3997  *
3998  * @vif_cfg_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to interface
3999  *	(MLD) parameters from &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg that vary during the
4000  *	lifetime of the interface (e.g. assoc status, IP addresses, etc.)
4001  *	The @changed parameter indicates which value changed.
4002  *	The callback can sleep.
4003  *
4004  * @link_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to link
4005  *	parameters from &struct ieee80211_bss_conf that are related to an
4006  *	individual link. e.g. legacy/HT/VHT/... rate information.
4007  *	The @changed parameter indicates which value changed, and the @link_id
4008  *	parameter indicates the link ID. Note that the @link_id will be 0 for
4009  *	non-MLO connections.
4010  *	The callback can sleep.
4011  *
4012  * @prepare_multicast: Prepare for multicast filter configuration.
4013  *	This callback is optional, and its return value is passed
4014  *	to configure_filter(). This callback must be atomic.
4015  *
4016  * @configure_filter: Configure the device's RX filter.
4017  *	See the section "Frame filtering" for more information.
4018  *	This callback must be implemented and can sleep.
4019  *
4020  * @config_iface_filter: Configure the interface's RX filter.
4021  *	This callback is optional and is used to configure which frames
4022  *	should be passed to mac80211. The filter_flags is the combination
4023  *	of FIF_* flags. The changed_flags is a bit mask that indicates
4024  *	which flags are changed.
4025  *	This callback can sleep.
4026  *
4027  * @set_tim: Set TIM bit. mac80211 calls this function when a TIM bit
4028  * 	must be set or cleared for a given STA. Must be atomic.
4029  *
4030  * @set_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
4031  *	This callback is only called between add_interface and
4032  *	remove_interface calls, i.e. while the given virtual interface
4033  *	is enabled.
4034  *	Returns a negative error code if the key can't be added.
4035  *	The callback can sleep.
4036  *
4037  * @update_tkip_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
4038  * 	This callback will be called in the context of Rx. Called for drivers
4039  * 	which set IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_TKIP_REQ_RX_P1_KEY.
4040  *	The callback must be atomic.
4041  *
4042  * @set_rekey_data: If the device supports GTK rekeying, for example while the
4043  *	host is suspended, it can assign this callback to retrieve the data
4044  *	necessary to do GTK rekeying, this is the KEK, KCK and replay counter.
4045  *	After rekeying was done it should (for example during resume) notify
4046  *	userspace of the new replay counter using ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify().
4047  *
4048  * @set_default_unicast_key: Set the default (unicast) key index, useful for
4049  *	WEP when the device sends data packets autonomously, e.g. for ARP
4050  *	offloading. The index can be 0-3, or -1 for unsetting it.
4051  *
4052  * @hw_scan: Ask the hardware to service the scan request, no need to start
4053  *	the scan state machine in stack. The scan must honour the channel
4054  *	configuration done by the regulatory agent in the wiphy's
4055  *	registered bands. The hardware (or the driver) needs to make sure
4056  *	that power save is disabled.
4057  *	The @req ie/ie_len members are rewritten by mac80211 to contain the
4058  *	entire IEs after the SSID, so that drivers need not look at these
4059  *	at all but just send them after the SSID -- mac80211 includes the
4060  *	(extended) supported rates and HT information (where applicable).
4061  *	When the scan finishes, ieee80211_scan_completed() must be called;
4062  *	note that it also must be called when the scan cannot finish due to
4063  *	any error unless this callback returned a negative error code.
4064  *	This callback is also allowed to return the special return value 1,
4065  *	this indicates that hardware scan isn't desirable right now and a
4066  *	software scan should be done instead. A driver wishing to use this
4067  *	capability must ensure its (hardware) scan capabilities aren't
4068  *	advertised as more capable than mac80211's software scan is.
4069  *	The callback can sleep.
4070  *
4071  * @cancel_hw_scan: Ask the low-level tp cancel the active hw scan.
4072  *	The driver should ask the hardware to cancel the scan (if possible),
4073  *	but the scan will be completed only after the driver will call
4074  *	ieee80211_scan_completed().
4075  *	This callback is needed for wowlan, to prevent enqueueing a new
4076  *	scan_work after the low-level driver was already suspended.
4077  *	The callback can sleep.
4078  *
4079  * @sched_scan_start: Ask the hardware to start scanning repeatedly at
4080  *	specific intervals.  The driver must call the
4081  *	ieee80211_sched_scan_results() function whenever it finds results.
4082  *	This process will continue until sched_scan_stop is called.
4083  *
4084  * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the hardware to stop an ongoing scheduled scan.
4085  *	In this case, ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped() must not be called.
4086  *
4087  * @sw_scan_start: Notifier function that is called just before a software scan
4088  *	is started. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need this notification.
4089  *	The mac_addr parameter allows supporting NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR,
4090  *	the driver may set the NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR flag if it
4091  *	can use this parameter. The callback can sleep.
4092  *
4093  * @sw_scan_complete: Notifier function that is called just after a
4094  *	software scan finished. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need
4095  *	this notification.
4096  *	The callback can sleep.
4097  *
4098  * @get_stats: Return low-level statistics.
4099  * 	Returns zero if statistics are available.
4100  *	The callback can sleep.
4101  *
4102  * @get_key_seq: If your device implements encryption in hardware and does
4103  *	IV/PN assignment then this callback should be provided to read the
4104  *	IV/PN for the given key from hardware.
4105  *	The callback must be atomic.
4106  *
4107  * @set_frag_threshold: Configuration of fragmentation threshold. Assign this
4108  *	if the device does fragmentation by itself. Note that to prevent the
4109  *	stack from doing fragmentation IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG
4110  *	should be set as well.
4111  *	The callback can sleep.
4112  *
4113  * @set_rts_threshold: Configuration of RTS threshold (if device needs it)
4114  *	The callback can sleep.
4115  *
4116  * @sta_add: Notifies low level driver about addition of an associated station,
4117  *	AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. This callback can sleep.
4118  *
4119  * @sta_remove: Notifies low level driver about removal of an associated
4120  *	station, AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. Note that after the callback
4121  *	returns it isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected;
4122  *	no RCU grace period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing
4123  *	the station. See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
4124  *	This callback can sleep.
4125  *
4126  * @vif_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add a debugfs vif
4127  *	directory with its files. This callback should be within a
4128  *	CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This callback can sleep.
4129  *
4130  * @link_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
4131  *	when a link is added to a mac80211 vif. This callback should be within
4132  *	a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This callback can sleep.
4133  *	For non-MLO the callback will be called once for the default bss_conf
4134  *	with the vif's directory rather than a separate subdirectory.
4135  *
4136  * @sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
4137  *	when a station is added to mac80211's station list. This callback
4138  *	should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This
4139  *	callback can sleep.
4140  *
4141  * @link_sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
4142  *	when a link is added to a mac80211 station. This callback
4143  *	should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This
4144  *	callback can sleep.
4145  *	For non-MLO the callback will be called once for the deflink with the
4146  *	station's directory rather than a separate subdirectory.
4147  *
4148  * @sta_notify: Notifies low level driver about power state transition of an
4149  *	associated station, AP,  IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. For a VIF operating
4150  *	in AP mode, this callback will not be called when the flag
4151  *	%IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS is set. Must be atomic.
4152  *
4153  * @sta_set_txpwr: Configure the station tx power. This callback set the tx
4154  *	power for the station.
4155  *	This callback can sleep.
4156  *
4157  * @sta_state: Notifies low level driver about state transition of a
4158  *	station (which can be the AP, a client, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc.)
4159  *	This callback is mutually exclusive with @sta_add/@sta_remove.
4160  *	It must not fail for down transitions but may fail for transitions
4161  *	up the list of states. Also note that after the callback returns it
4162  *	isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected - no RCU grace
4163  *	period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing the station.
4164  *	See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
4165  *	The callback can sleep.
4166  *
4167  * @sta_pre_rcu_remove: Notify driver about station removal before RCU
4168  *	synchronisation. This is useful if a driver needs to have station
4169  *	pointers protected using RCU, it can then use this call to clear
4170  *	the pointers instead of waiting for an RCU grace period to elapse
4171  *	in @sta_state.
4172  *	The callback can sleep.
4173  *
4174  * @link_sta_rc_update: Notifies the driver of changes to the bitrates that can
4175  *	be used to transmit to the station. The changes are advertised with bits
4176  *	from &enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed and the values are reflected
4177  *	in the station data. This callback should only be used when the driver
4178  *	uses hardware rate control (%IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL) since
4179  *	otherwise the rate control algorithm is notified directly.
4180  *	Must be atomic.
4181  * @sta_rate_tbl_update: Notifies the driver that the rate table changed. This
4182  *	is only used if the configured rate control algorithm actually uses
4183  *	the new rate table API, and is therefore optional. Must be atomic.
4184  *
4185  * @sta_statistics: Get statistics for this station. For example with beacon
4186  *	filtering, the statistics kept by mac80211 might not be accurate, so
4187  *	let the driver pre-fill the statistics. The driver can fill most of
4188  *	the values (indicating which by setting the filled bitmap), but not
4189  *	all of them make sense - see the source for which ones are possible.
4190  *	Statistics that the driver doesn't fill will be filled by mac80211.
4191  *	The callback can sleep.
4192  *
4193  * @link_sta_statistics: Get link statistics for this station. For example with
4194  *	beacon filtering, the statistics kept by mac80211 might not be
4195  *	accurate, so let the driver pre-fill the statistics. The driver can
4196  *	fill most of the values (indicating which by setting the filled
4197  *	bitmap), but not all of them make sense - see the source for which
4198  *	ones are possible.
4199  *	Statistics that the driver doesn't fill will be filled by mac80211.
4200  *	The callback can sleep.
4201  *
4202  * @conf_tx: Configure TX queue parameters (EDCF (aifs, cw_min, cw_max),
4203  *	bursting) for a hardware TX queue.
4204  *	Returns a negative error code on failure.
4205  *	The callback can sleep.
4206  *
4207  * @get_tsf: Get the current TSF timer value from firmware/hardware. Currently,
4208  *	this is only used for IBSS mode BSSID merging and debugging. Is not a
4209  *	required function.
4210  *	The callback can sleep.
4211  *
4212  * @set_tsf: Set the TSF timer to the specified value in the firmware/hardware.
4213  *	Currently, this is only used for IBSS mode debugging. Is not a
4214  *	required function.
4215  *	The callback can sleep.
4216  *
4217  * @offset_tsf: Offset the TSF timer by the specified value in the
4218  *	firmware/hardware.  Preferred to set_tsf as it avoids delay between
4219  *	calling set_tsf() and hardware getting programmed, which will show up
4220  *	as TSF delay. Is not a required function.
4221  *	The callback can sleep.
4222  *
4223  * @reset_tsf: Reset the TSF timer and allow firmware/hardware to synchronize
4224  *	with other STAs in the IBSS. This is only used in IBSS mode. This
4225  *	function is optional if the firmware/hardware takes full care of
4226  *	TSF synchronization.
4227  *	The callback can sleep.
4228  *
4229  * @tx_last_beacon: Determine whether the last IBSS beacon was sent by us.
4230  *	This is needed only for IBSS mode and the result of this function is
4231  *	used to determine whether to reply to Probe Requests.
4232  *	Returns non-zero if this device sent the last beacon.
4233  *	The callback can sleep.
4234  *
4235  * @get_survey: Return per-channel survey information
4236  *
4237  * @rfkill_poll: Poll rfkill hardware state. If you need this, you also
4238  *	need to set wiphy->rfkill_poll to %true before registration,
4239  *	and need to call wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state() in the callback.
4240  *	The callback can sleep.
4241  *
4242  * @set_coverage_class: Set slot time for given coverage class as specified
4243  *	in IEEE 802.11-2007 section 17.3.8.6 and modify ACK timeout
4244  *	accordingly; coverage class equals to -1 to enable ACK timeout
4245  *	estimation algorithm (dynack). To disable dynack set valid value for
4246  *	coverage class. This callback is not required and may sleep.
4247  *
4248  * @testmode_cmd: Implement a cfg80211 test mode command. The passed @vif may
4249  *	be %NULL. The callback can sleep.
4250  * @testmode_dump: Implement a cfg80211 test mode dump. The callback can sleep.
4251  *
4252  * @flush: Flush all pending frames from the hardware queue, making sure
4253  *	that the hardware queues are empty. The @queues parameter is a bitmap
4254  *	of queues to flush, which is useful if different virtual interfaces
4255  *	use different hardware queues; it may also indicate all queues.
4256  *	If the parameter @drop is set to %true, pending frames may be dropped.
4257  *	Note that vif can be NULL.
4258  *	The callback can sleep.
4259  *
4260  * @flush_sta: Flush or drop all pending frames from the hardware queue(s) for
4261  *	the given station, as it's about to be removed.
4262  *	The callback can sleep.
4263  *
4264  * @channel_switch: Drivers that need (or want) to offload the channel
4265  *	switch operation for CSAs received from the AP may implement this
4266  *	callback. They must then call ieee80211_chswitch_done() to indicate
4267  *	completion of the channel switch.
4268  *
4269  * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device.
4270  *	Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may
4271  *	reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL
4272  *	(also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX).
4273  *
4274  * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant).
4275  *
4276  * @remain_on_channel: Starts an off-channel period on the given channel, must
4277  *	call back to ieee80211_ready_on_channel() when on that channel. Note
4278  *	that normal channel traffic is not stopped as this is intended for hw
4279  *	offload. Frames to transmit on the off-channel channel are transmitted
4280  *	normally except for the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN flag. When the
4281  *	duration (which will always be non-zero) expires, the driver must call
4282  *	ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired().
4283  *	Note that this callback may be called while the device is in IDLE and
4284  *	must be accepted in this case.
4285  *	This callback may sleep.
4286  * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Requests that an ongoing off-channel period is
4287  *	aborted before it expires. This callback may sleep.
4288  *
4289  * @set_ringparam: Set tx and rx ring sizes.
4290  *
4291  * @get_ringparam: Get tx and rx ring current and maximum sizes.
4292  *
4293  * @tx_frames_pending: Check if there is any pending frame in the hardware
4294  *	queues before entering power save.
4295  *
4296  * @set_bitrate_mask: Set a mask of rates to be used for rate control selection
4297  *	when transmitting a frame. Currently only legacy rates are handled.
4298  *	The callback can sleep.
4299  * @event_callback: Notify driver about any event in mac80211. See
4300  *	&enum ieee80211_event_type for the different types.
4301  *	The callback must be atomic.
4302  *
4303  * @release_buffered_frames: Release buffered frames according to the given
4304  *	parameters. In the case where the driver buffers some frames for
4305  *	sleeping stations mac80211 will use this callback to tell the driver
4306  *	to release some frames, either for PS-poll or uAPSD.
4307  *	Note that if the @more_data parameter is %false the driver must check
4308  *	if there are more frames on the given TIDs, and if there are more than
4309  *	the frames being released then it must still set the more-data bit in
4310  *	the frame. If the @more_data parameter is %true, then of course the
4311  *	more-data bit must always be set.
4312  *	The @tids parameter tells the driver which TIDs to release frames
4313  *	from, for PS-poll it will always have only a single bit set.
4314  *	In the case this is used for a PS-poll initiated release, the
4315  *	@num_frames parameter will always be 1 so code can be shared. In
4316  *	this case the driver must also set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
4317  *	on the TX status (and must report TX status) so that the PS-poll
4318  *	period is properly ended. This is used to avoid sending multiple
4319  *	responses for a retried PS-poll frame.
4320  *	In the case this is used for uAPSD, the @num_frames parameter may be
4321  *	bigger than one, but the driver may send fewer frames (it must send
4322  *	at least one, however). In this case it is also responsible for
4323  *	setting the EOSP flag in the QoS header of the frames. Also, when the
4324  *	service period ends, the driver must set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP
4325  *	on the last frame in the SP. Alternatively, it may call the function
4326  *	ieee80211_sta_eosp() to inform mac80211 of the end of the SP.
4327  *	This callback must be atomic.
4328  * @allow_buffered_frames: Prepare device to allow the given number of frames
4329  *	to go out to the given station. The frames will be sent by mac80211
4330  *	via the usual TX path after this call. The TX information for frames
4331  *	released will also have the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER flag set
4332  *	and the last one will also have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set. In case
4333  *	frames from multiple TIDs are released and the driver might reorder
4334  *	them between the TIDs, it must set the %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
4335  *	on the last frame and clear it on all others and also handle the EOSP
4336  *	bit in the QoS header correctly. Alternatively, it can also call the
4337  *	ieee80211_sta_eosp() function.
4338  *	The @tids parameter is a bitmap and tells the driver which TIDs the
4339  *	frames will be on; it will at most have two bits set.
4340  *	This callback must be atomic.
4341  *
4342  * @get_et_sset_count:  Ethtool API to get string-set count.
4343  *	Note that the wiphy mutex is not held for this callback since it's
4344  *	expected to return a static value.
4345  *
4346  * @get_et_stats:  Ethtool API to get a set of u64 stats.
4347  *
4348  * @get_et_strings:  Ethtool API to get a set of strings to describe stats
4349  *	and perhaps other supported types of ethtool data-sets.
4350  *	Note that the wiphy mutex is not held for this callback since it's
4351  *	expected to return a static value.
4352  *
4353  * @mgd_prepare_tx: Prepare for transmitting a management frame for association
4354  *	before associated. In multi-channel scenarios, a virtual interface is
4355  *	bound to a channel before it is associated, but as it isn't associated
4356  *	yet it need not necessarily be given airtime, in particular since any
4357  *	transmission to a P2P GO needs to be synchronized against the GO's
4358  *	powersave state. mac80211 will call this function before transmitting a
4359  *	management frame prior to transmitting that frame to allow the driver
4360  *	to give it channel time for the transmission, to get a response and be
4361  *	able to synchronize with the GO.
4362  *	The callback will be called before each transmission and upon return
4363  *	mac80211 will transmit the frame right away.
4364  *	Additional information is passed in the &struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info
4365  *	data. If duration there is greater than zero, mac80211 hints to the
4366  *	driver the duration for which the operation is requested.
4367  *	The callback is optional and can (should!) sleep.
4368  * @mgd_complete_tx: Notify the driver that the response frame for a previously
4369  *	transmitted frame announced with @mgd_prepare_tx was received, the data
4370  *	is filled similarly to @mgd_prepare_tx though the duration is not used.
4371  *	Note that this isn't always called for each mgd_prepare_tx() call, for
4372  *	example for SAE the 'confirm' messages can be on the air in any order.
4373  *
4374  * @mgd_protect_tdls_discover: Protect a TDLS discovery session. After sending
4375  *	a TDLS discovery-request, we expect a reply to arrive on the AP's
4376  *	channel. We must stay on the channel (no PSM, scan, etc.), since a TDLS
4377  *	setup-response is a direct packet not buffered by the AP.
4378  *	mac80211 will call this function just before the transmission of a TDLS
4379  *	discovery-request. The recommended period of protection is at least
4380  *	2 * (DTIM period).
4381  *	The callback is optional and can sleep.
4382  *
4383  * @add_chanctx: Notifies device driver about new channel context creation.
4384  *	This callback may sleep.
4385  * @remove_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context destruction.
4386  *	This callback may sleep.
4387  * @change_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context changes that
4388  *	may happen when combining different virtual interfaces on the same
4389  *	channel context with different settings
4390  *	This callback may sleep.
4391  * @assign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being bound
4392  *	to vif. Possible use is for hw queue remapping.
4393  *	This callback may sleep.
4394  * @unassign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being
4395  *	unbound from vif.
4396  *	This callback may sleep.
4397  * @switch_vif_chanctx: switch a number of vifs from one chanctx to
4398  *	another, as specified in the list of
4399  *	@ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch passed to the driver, according
4400  *	to the mode defined in &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode.
4401  *	This callback may sleep.
4402  *
4403  * @start_ap: Start operation on the AP interface, this is called after all the
4404  *	information in bss_conf is set and beacon can be retrieved. A channel
4405  *	context is bound before this is called. Note that if the driver uses
4406  *	software scan or ROC, this (and @stop_ap) isn't called when the AP is
4407  *	just "paused" for scanning/ROC, which is indicated by the beacon being
4408  *	disabled/enabled via @bss_info_changed.
4409  * @stop_ap: Stop operation on the AP interface.
4410  *
4411  * @reconfig_complete: Called after a call to ieee80211_restart_hw() and
4412  *	during resume, when the reconfiguration has completed.
4413  *	This can help the driver implement the reconfiguration step (and
4414  *	indicate mac80211 is ready to receive frames).
4415  *	This callback may sleep.
4416  *
4417  * @ipv6_addr_change: IPv6 address assignment on the given interface changed.
4418  *	Currently, this is only called for managed or P2P client interfaces.
4419  *	This callback is optional; it must not sleep.
4420  *
4421  * @channel_switch_beacon: Starts a channel switch to a new channel.
4422  *	Beacons are modified to include CSA or ECSA IEs before calling this
4423  *	function. The corresponding count fields in these IEs must be
4424  *	decremented, and when they reach 1 the driver must call
4425  *	ieee80211_csa_finish(). Drivers which use ieee80211_beacon_get()
4426  *	get the csa counter decremented by mac80211, but must check if it is
4427  *	1 using ieee80211_beacon_counter_is_complete() after the beacon has been
4428  *	transmitted and then call ieee80211_csa_finish().
4429  *	If the CSA count starts as zero or 1, this function will not be called,
4430  *	since there won't be any time to beacon before the switch anyway.
4431  * @pre_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4432  *	before a channel switch procedure is started (ie. when a STA
4433  *	gets a CSA or a userspace initiated channel-switch), allowing
4434  *	the driver to prepare for the channel switch.
4435  * @post_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4436  *	after a channel switch procedure is completed, allowing the
4437  *	driver to go back to a normal configuration.
4438  * @abort_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4439  *	when channel switch procedure was aborted, allowing the
4440  *	driver to go back to a normal configuration.
4441  * @channel_switch_rx_beacon: This is an optional callback that is called
4442  *	when channel switch procedure is in progress and additional beacon with
4443  *	CSA IE was received, allowing driver to track changes in count.
4444  * @join_ibss: Join an IBSS (on an IBSS interface); this is called after all
4445  *	information in bss_conf is set up and the beacon can be retrieved. A
4446  *	channel context is bound before this is called.
4447  * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS again.
4448  *
4449  * @get_expected_throughput: extract the expected throughput towards the
4450  *	specified station. The returned value is expressed in Kbps. It returns 0
4451  *	if the RC algorithm does not have proper data to provide.
4452  *
4453  * @get_txpower: get current maximum tx power (in dBm) based on configuration
4454  *	and hardware limits.
4455  *
4456  * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver
4457  *	is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations
4458  *	and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP. The
4459  *	driver receives a channel-switch request template and the location of
4460  *	the switch-timing IE within the template as part of the invocation.
4461  *	The template is valid only within the call, and the driver can
4462  *	optionally copy the skb for further re-use.
4463  * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both
4464  *	peers must be on the base channel when the call completes.
4465  * @tdls_recv_channel_switch: a TDLS channel-switch related frame (request or
4466  *	response) has been received from a remote peer. The driver gets
4467  *	parameters parsed from the incoming frame and may use them to continue
4468  *	an ongoing channel-switch operation. In addition, a channel-switch
4469  *	response template is provided, together with the location of the
4470  *	switch-timing IE within the template. The skb can only be used within
4471  *	the function call.
4472  *
4473  * @wake_tx_queue: Called when new packets have been added to the queue.
4474  * @sync_rx_queues: Process all pending frames in RSS queues. This is a
4475  *	synchronization which is needed in case driver has in its RSS queues
4476  *	pending frames that were received prior to the control path action
4477  *	currently taken (e.g. disassociation) but are not processed yet.
4478  *
4479  * @start_nan: join an existing NAN cluster, or create a new one.
4480  * @stop_nan: leave the NAN cluster.
4481  * @nan_change_conf: change NAN configuration. The data in cfg80211_nan_conf
4482  *	contains full new configuration and changes specify which parameters
4483  *	are changed with respect to the last NAN config.
4484  *	The driver gets both full configuration and the changed parameters since
4485  *	some devices may need the full configuration while others need only the
4486  *	changed parameters.
4487  * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns 0 on success. The data in
4488  *	cfg80211_nan_func must not be referenced outside the scope of
4489  *	this call.
4490  * @del_nan_func: Remove a NAN function. The driver must call
4491  *	ieee80211_nan_func_terminated() with
4492  *	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST reason code upon removal.
4493  * @can_aggregate_in_amsdu: Called in order to determine if HW supports
4494  *	aggregating two specific frames in the same A-MSDU. The relation
4495  *	between the skbs should be symmetric and transitive. Note that while
4496  *	skb is always a real frame, head may or may not be an A-MSDU.
4497  * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available.
4498  *	Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided.
4499  *
4500  * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM) (this call can sleep)
4501  * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement (this call can sleep)
4502  * @set_tid_config: Apply TID specific configurations. This callback may sleep.
4503  * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer.
4504  *	This callback may sleep.
4505  * @update_vif_offload: Update virtual interface offload flags
4506  *	This callback may sleep.
4507  * @sta_set_4addr: Called to notify the driver when a station starts/stops using
4508  *	4-address mode
4509  * @set_sar_specs: Update the SAR (TX power) settings.
4510  * @sta_set_decap_offload: Called to notify the driver when a station is allowed
4511  *	to use rx decapsulation offload
4512  * @add_twt_setup: Update hw with TWT agreement parameters received from the peer.
4513  *	This callback allows the hw to check if requested parameters
4514  *	are supported and if there is enough room for a new agreement.
4515  *	The hw is expected to set agreement result in the req_type field of
4516  *	twt structure.
4517  * @twt_teardown_request: Update the hw with TWT teardown request received
4518  *	from the peer.
4519  * @set_radar_background: Configure dedicated offchannel chain available for
4520  *	radar/CAC detection on some hw. This chain can't be used to transmit
4521  *	or receive frames and it is bounded to a running wdev.
4522  *	Background radar/CAC detection allows to avoid the CAC downtime
4523  *	switching to a different channel during CAC detection on the selected
4524  *	radar channel.
4525  *	The caller is expected to set chandef pointer to NULL in order to
4526  *	disable background CAC/radar detection.
4527  * @net_fill_forward_path: Called from .ndo_fill_forward_path in order to
4528  *	resolve a path for hardware flow offloading
4529  * @can_activate_links: Checks if a specific active_links bitmap is
4530  *	supported by the driver.
4531  * @change_vif_links: Change the valid links on an interface, note that while
4532  *	removing the old link information is still valid (link_conf pointer),
4533  *	but may immediately disappear after the function returns. The old or
4534  *	new links bitmaps may be 0 if going from/to a non-MLO situation.
4535  *	The @old array contains pointers to the old bss_conf structures
4536  *	that were already removed, in case they're needed.
4537  *	Note that removal of link should always succeed, so the return value
4538  *	will be ignored in a removal only case.
4539  *	This callback can sleep.
4540  * @change_sta_links: Change the valid links of a station, similar to
4541  *	@change_vif_links. This callback can sleep.
4542  *	Note that a sta can also be inserted or removed with valid links,
4543  *	i.e. passed to @sta_add/@sta_state with sta->valid_links not zero.
4544  *	In fact, cannot change from having valid_links and not having them.
4545  * @set_hw_timestamp: Enable/disable HW timestamping of TM/FTM frames. This is
4546  *	not restored at HW reset by mac80211 so drivers need to take care of
4547  *	that.
4548  * @net_setup_tc: Called from .ndo_setup_tc in order to prepare hardware
4549  *	flow offloading for flows originating from the vif.
4550  *	Note that the driver must not assume that the vif driver_data is valid
4551  *	at this point, since the callback can be called during netdev teardown.
4552  * @can_neg_ttlm: for managed interface, requests the driver to determine
4553  *	if the requested TID-To-Link mapping can be accepted or not.
4554  *	If it's not accepted the driver may suggest a preferred mapping and
4555  *	modify @ttlm parameter with the suggested TID-to-Link mapping.
4556  * @prep_add_interface: prepare for interface addition. This can be used by
4557  *      drivers to prepare for the addition of a new interface, e.g., allocate
4558  *      the needed resources etc. This callback doesn't guarantee that an
4559  *      interface with the specified type would be added, and thus drivers that
4560  *      implement this callback need to handle such cases. The type is the full
4561  *      &enum nl80211_iftype.
4562  * @set_eml_op_mode: Configure eMLSR/eMLMR operation mode in the underlay
4563  *	driver according to the parameter received in the EML Operating mode
4564  *	notification frame.
4565  */
4566 struct ieee80211_ops {
4567 	void (*tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4568 		   struct ieee80211_tx_control *control,
4569 		   struct sk_buff *skb);
4570 	int (*start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4571 	void (*stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, bool suspend);
4572 #ifdef CONFIG_PM
4573 	int (*suspend)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan);
4574 	int (*resume)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4575 	void (*set_wakeup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, bool enabled);
4576 #endif
4577 	int (*add_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4578 			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4579 	int (*change_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4580 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4581 				enum nl80211_iftype new_type, bool p2p);
4582 	void (*remove_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4583 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4584 	int (*config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int radio_idx, u32 changed);
4585 	void (*bss_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4586 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4587 				 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
4588 				 u64 changed);
4589 	void (*vif_cfg_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4590 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4591 				u64 changed);
4592 	void (*link_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4593 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4594 				  struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
4595 				  u64 changed);
4596 
4597 	int (*start_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4598 			struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4599 	void (*stop_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4600 			struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4601 
4602 	u64 (*prepare_multicast)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4603 				 struct netdev_hw_addr_list *mc_list);
4604 	void (*configure_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4605 				 unsigned int changed_flags,
4606 				 unsigned int *total_flags,
4607 				 u64 multicast);
4608 	void (*config_iface_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4609 				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4610 				    unsigned int filter_flags,
4611 				    unsigned int changed_flags);
4612 	int (*set_tim)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4613 		       bool set);
4614 	int (*set_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, enum set_key_cmd cmd,
4615 		       struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4616 		       struct ieee80211_key_conf *key);
4617 	void (*update_tkip_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4618 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4619 				struct ieee80211_key_conf *conf,
4620 				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4621 				u32 iv32, u16 *phase1key);
4622 	void (*set_rekey_data)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4623 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4624 			       struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data);
4625 	void (*set_default_unicast_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4626 					struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int idx);
4627 	int (*hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4628 		       struct ieee80211_scan_request *req);
4629 	void (*cancel_hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4630 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4631 	int (*sched_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4632 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4633 				struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *req,
4634 				struct ieee80211_scan_ies *ies);
4635 	int (*sched_scan_stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4636 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4637 	void (*sw_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4638 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4639 			      const u8 *mac_addr);
4640 	void (*sw_scan_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4641 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4642 	int (*get_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4643 			 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats *stats);
4644 	void (*get_key_seq)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4645 			    struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
4646 			    struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
4647 	int (*set_frag_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int radio_idx,
4648 				  u32 value);
4649 	int (*set_rts_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int radio_idx,
4650 				 u32 value);
4651 	int (*sta_add)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4652 		       struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4653 	int (*sta_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4654 			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4655 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
4656 	void (*vif_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4657 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4658 	void (*link_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4659 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4660 				 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4661 				 struct dentry *dir);
4662 	void (*sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4663 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4664 				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4665 				struct dentry *dir);
4666 	void (*link_sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4667 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4668 				     struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta,
4669 				     struct dentry *dir);
4670 #endif
4671 	void (*sta_notify)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4672 			enum sta_notify_cmd, struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4673 	int (*sta_set_txpwr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4674 			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4675 			     struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4676 	int (*sta_state)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4677 			 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4678 			 enum ieee80211_sta_state old_state,
4679 			 enum ieee80211_sta_state new_state);
4680 	void (*sta_pre_rcu_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4681 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4682 				   struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4683 	void (*link_sta_rc_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4684 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4685 				   struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta,
4686 				   u32 changed);
4687 	void (*sta_rate_tbl_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4688 				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4689 				    struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4690 	void (*sta_statistics)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4691 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4692 			       struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4693 			       struct station_info *sinfo);
4694 	int (*conf_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4695 		       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4696 		       unsigned int link_id, u16 ac,
4697 		       const struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params *params);
4698 	u64 (*get_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4699 	void (*set_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4700 			u64 tsf);
4701 	void (*offset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4702 			   s64 offset);
4703 	void (*reset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4704 	int (*tx_last_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4705 	void (*link_sta_statistics)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4706 				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4707 				    struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta,
4708 				    struct link_station_info *link_sinfo);
4709 
4710 	/**
4711 	 * @ampdu_action:
4712 	 * Perform a certain A-MPDU action.
4713 	 * The RA/TID combination determines the destination and TID we want
4714 	 * the ampdu action to be performed for. The action is defined through
4715 	 * ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
4716 	 * When the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL the driver
4717 	 * may neither send aggregates containing more subframes than @buf_size
4718 	 * nor send aggregates in a way that lost frames would exceed the
4719 	 * buffer size. If just limiting the aggregate size, this would be
4720 	 * possible with a buf_size of 8:
4721 	 *
4722 	 * - ``TX: 1.....7``
4723 	 * - ``RX:  2....7`` (lost frame #1)
4724 	 * - ``TX:        8..1...``
4725 	 *
4726 	 * which is invalid since #1 was now re-transmitted well past the
4727 	 * buffer size of 8. Correct ways to retransmit #1 would be:
4728 	 *
4729 	 * - ``TX:        1   or``
4730 	 * - ``TX:        18  or``
4731 	 * - ``TX:        81``
4732 	 *
4733 	 * Even ``189`` would be wrong since 1 could be lost again.
4734 	 *
4735 	 * Returns a negative error code on failure. The driver may return
4736 	 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE for %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START
4737 	 * if the session can start immediately.
4738 	 *
4739 	 * The callback can sleep.
4740 	 */
4741 	int (*ampdu_action)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4742 			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4743 			    struct ieee80211_ampdu_params *params);
4744 	int (*get_survey)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int idx,
4745 		struct survey_info *survey);
4746 	void (*rfkill_poll)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4747 	void (*set_coverage_class)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int radio_idx,
4748 				   s16 coverage_class);
4749 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
4750 	int (*testmode_cmd)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4751 			    void *data, int len);
4752 	int (*testmode_dump)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb,
4753 			     struct netlink_callback *cb,
4754 			     void *data, int len);
4755 #endif
4756 	void (*flush)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4757 		      u32 queues, bool drop);
4758 	void (*flush_sta)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4759 			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4760 	void (*channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4761 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4762 			       struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4763 	int (*set_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int radio_idx,
4764 			   u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant);
4765 	int (*get_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int radio_idx,
4766 			   u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant);
4767 
4768 	int (*remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4769 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4770 				 struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
4771 				 int duration,
4772 				 enum ieee80211_roc_type type);
4773 	int (*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4774 					struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4775 	int (*set_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx, u32 rx);
4776 	void (*get_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4777 			      u32 *tx, u32 *tx_max, u32 *rx, u32 *rx_max);
4778 	bool (*tx_frames_pending)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4779 	int (*set_bitrate_mask)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4780 				const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask);
4781 	void (*event_callback)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4782 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4783 			       const struct ieee80211_event *event);
4784 
4785 	void (*allow_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4786 				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4787 				      u16 tids, int num_frames,
4788 				      enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
4789 				      bool more_data);
4790 	void (*release_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4791 					struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4792 					u16 tids, int num_frames,
4793 					enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
4794 					bool more_data);
4795 
4796 	int	(*get_et_sset_count)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4797 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int sset);
4798 	void	(*get_et_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4799 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4800 				struct ethtool_stats *stats, u64 *data);
4801 	void	(*get_et_strings)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4802 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4803 				  u32 sset, u8 *data);
4804 
4805 	void	(*mgd_prepare_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4806 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4807 				  struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info);
4808 	void	(*mgd_complete_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4809 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4810 				   struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info);
4811 
4812 	void	(*mgd_protect_tdls_discover)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4813 					     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4814 					     unsigned int link_id);
4815 
4816 	int (*add_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4817 			   struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4818 	void (*remove_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4819 			       struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4820 	void (*change_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4821 			       struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx,
4822 			       u32 changed);
4823 	int (*assign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4824 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4825 				  struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4826 				  struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4827 	void (*unassign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4828 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4829 				     struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4830 				     struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4831 	int (*switch_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4832 				  struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch *vifs,
4833 				  int n_vifs,
4834 				  enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode mode);
4835 
4836 	void (*reconfig_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4837 				  enum ieee80211_reconfig_type reconfig_type);
4838 
4839 #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_IPV6)
4840 	void (*ipv6_addr_change)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4841 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4842 				 struct inet6_dev *idev);
4843 #endif
4844 	void (*channel_switch_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4845 				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4846 				      struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4847 	int (*pre_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4848 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4849 				  struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4850 
4851 	int (*post_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4852 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4853 				   struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4854 	void (*abort_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4855 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4856 				     struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4857 	void (*channel_switch_rx_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4858 					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4859 					 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4860 
4861 	int (*join_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4862 	void (*leave_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4863 	u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4864 				       struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4865 	int (*get_txpower)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4866 			   unsigned int link_id, int *dbm);
4867 
4868 	int (*tdls_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4869 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4870 				   struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 oper_class,
4871 				   struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
4872 				   struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb, u32 ch_sw_tm_ie);
4873 	void (*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4874 					   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4875 					   struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4876 	void (*tdls_recv_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4877 					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4878 					 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params *params);
4879 
4880 	void (*wake_tx_queue)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4881 			      struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
4882 	void (*sync_rx_queues)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4883 
4884 	int (*start_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4885 			 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4886 			 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf);
4887 	int (*stop_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4888 			struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4889 	int (*nan_change_conf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4890 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4891 			       struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf, u32 changes);
4892 	int (*add_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4893 			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4894 			    const struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func);
4895 	void (*del_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4896 			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4897 			    u8 instance_id);
4898 	bool (*can_aggregate_in_amsdu)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4899 				       struct sk_buff *head,
4900 				       struct sk_buff *skb);
4901 	int (*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4902 				       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4903 				       struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats);
4904 	int (*start_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4905 			  struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4906 	void (*abort_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4907 			   struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4908 	int (*set_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4909 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4910 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4911 			      struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf);
4912 	int (*reset_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4913 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4914 				struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tids);
4915 	void (*update_vif_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4916 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4917 	void (*sta_set_4addr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4918 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled);
4919 	int (*set_sar_specs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4920 			     const struct cfg80211_sar_specs *sar);
4921 	void (*sta_set_decap_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4922 				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4923 				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled);
4924 	void (*add_twt_setup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4925 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4926 			      struct ieee80211_twt_setup *twt);
4927 	void (*twt_teardown_request)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4928 				     struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 flowid);
4929 	int (*set_radar_background)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4930 				    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4931 	int (*net_fill_forward_path)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4932 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4933 				     struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4934 				     struct net_device_path_ctx *ctx,
4935 				     struct net_device_path *path);
4936 	bool (*can_activate_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4937 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4938 				   u16 active_links);
4939 	int (*change_vif_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4940 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4941 				u16 old_links, u16 new_links,
4942 				struct ieee80211_bss_conf *old[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]);
4943 	int (*change_sta_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4944 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4945 				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4946 				u16 old_links, u16 new_links);
4947 	int (*set_hw_timestamp)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4948 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4949 				struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp *hwts);
4950 	int (*net_setup_tc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4951 			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4952 			    struct net_device *dev,
4953 			    enum tc_setup_type type,
4954 			    void *type_data);
4955 	enum ieee80211_neg_ttlm_res
4956 	(*can_neg_ttlm)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4957 			struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm *ttlm);
4958 	void (*prep_add_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4959 				   enum nl80211_iftype type);
4960 	int (*set_eml_op_mode)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4961 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4962 			       struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4963 			       struct ieee80211_eml_params *eml_params);
4964 };
4965 
4966 /**
4967  * ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm - Allocate a new hardware device
4968  *
4969  * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
4970  * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
4971  * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
4972  * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
4973  * @priv_data_len.
4974  *
4975  * @priv_data_len: length of private data
4976  * @ops: callbacks for this device
4977  * @requested_name: Requested name for this device.
4978  *	NULL is valid value, and means use the default naming (phy%d)
4979  *
4980  * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
4981  */
4982 struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(size_t priv_data_len,
4983 					   const struct ieee80211_ops *ops,
4984 					   const char *requested_name);
4985 
4986 /**
4987  * ieee80211_alloc_hw - Allocate a new hardware device
4988  *
4989  * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
4990  * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
4991  * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
4992  * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
4993  * @priv_data_len.
4994  *
4995  * @priv_data_len: length of private data
4996  * @ops: callbacks for this device
4997  *
4998  * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
4999  */
5000 static inline
5001 struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw(size_t priv_data_len,
5002 					const struct ieee80211_ops *ops)
5003 {
5004 	return ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(priv_data_len, ops, NULL);
5005 }
5006 
5007 /**
5008  * ieee80211_register_hw - Register hardware device
5009  *
5010  * You must call this function before any other functions in
5011  * mac80211. Note that before a hardware can be registered, you
5012  * need to fill the contained wiphy's information.
5013  *
5014  * @hw: the device to register as returned by ieee80211_alloc_hw()
5015  *
5016  * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise.
5017  */
5018 int ieee80211_register_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5019 
5020 /**
5021  * struct ieee80211_tpt_blink - throughput blink description
5022  * @throughput: throughput in Kbit/sec
5023  * @blink_time: blink time in milliseconds
5024  *	(full cycle, ie. one off + one on period)
5025  */
5026 struct ieee80211_tpt_blink {
5027 	int throughput;
5028 	int blink_time;
5029 };
5030 
5031 /**
5032  * enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags - throughput trigger flags
5033  * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO: enable blinking with radio
5034  * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK: enable blinking when working
5035  * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED: enable blinking when at least one
5036  *	interface is connected in some way, including being an AP
5037  */
5038 enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags {
5039 	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO		= BIT(0),
5040 	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK		= BIT(1),
5041 	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED	= BIT(2),
5042 };
5043 
5044 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
5045 const char *__ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5046 const char *__ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5047 const char *__ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5048 const char *__ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5049 const char *
5050 __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5051 				   unsigned int flags,
5052 				   const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
5053 				   unsigned int blink_table_len);
5054 #endif
5055 /**
5056  * ieee80211_get_tx_led_name - get name of TX LED
5057  *
5058  * mac80211 creates a transmit LED trigger for each wireless hardware
5059  * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
5060  * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
5061  * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
5062  *
5063  * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
5064  *
5065  * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
5066  */
5067 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
5068 {
5069 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
5070 	return __ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(hw);
5071 #else
5072 	return NULL;
5073 #endif
5074 }
5075 
5076 /**
5077  * ieee80211_get_rx_led_name - get name of RX LED
5078  *
5079  * mac80211 creates a receive LED trigger for each wireless hardware
5080  * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
5081  * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
5082  * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
5083  *
5084  * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
5085  *
5086  * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
5087  */
5088 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
5089 {
5090 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
5091 	return __ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(hw);
5092 #else
5093 	return NULL;
5094 #endif
5095 }
5096 
5097 /**
5098  * ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name - get name of association LED
5099  *
5100  * mac80211 creates a association LED trigger for each wireless hardware
5101  * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
5102  * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
5103  * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
5104  *
5105  * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
5106  *
5107  * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
5108  */
5109 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
5110 {
5111 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
5112 	return __ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(hw);
5113 #else
5114 	return NULL;
5115 #endif
5116 }
5117 
5118 /**
5119  * ieee80211_get_radio_led_name - get name of radio LED
5120  *
5121  * mac80211 creates a radio change LED trigger for each wireless hardware
5122  * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
5123  * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
5124  * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
5125  *
5126  * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
5127  *
5128  * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
5129  */
5130 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
5131 {
5132 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
5133 	return __ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(hw);
5134 #else
5135 	return NULL;
5136 #endif
5137 }
5138 
5139 /**
5140  * ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger - create throughput LED trigger
5141  * @hw: the hardware to create the trigger for
5142  * @flags: trigger flags, see &enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags
5143  * @blink_table: the blink table -- needs to be ordered by throughput
5144  * @blink_table_len: size of the blink table
5145  *
5146  * Return: %NULL (in case of error, or if no LED triggers are
5147  * configured) or the name of the new trigger.
5148  *
5149  * Note: This function must be called before ieee80211_register_hw().
5150  */
5151 static inline const char *
5152 ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, unsigned int flags,
5153 				 const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
5154 				 unsigned int blink_table_len)
5155 {
5156 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
5157 	return __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(hw, flags, blink_table,
5158 						  blink_table_len);
5159 #else
5160 	return NULL;
5161 #endif
5162 }
5163 
5164 /**
5165  * ieee80211_unregister_hw - Unregister a hardware device
5166  *
5167  * This function instructs mac80211 to free allocated resources
5168  * and unregister netdevices from the networking subsystem.
5169  *
5170  * @hw: the hardware to unregister
5171  */
5172 void ieee80211_unregister_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5173 
5174 /**
5175  * ieee80211_free_hw - free hardware descriptor
5176  *
5177  * This function frees everything that was allocated, including the
5178  * private data for the driver. You must call ieee80211_unregister_hw()
5179  * before calling this function.
5180  *
5181  * @hw: the hardware to free
5182  */
5183 void ieee80211_free_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5184 
5185 /**
5186  * ieee80211_restart_hw - restart hardware completely
5187  *
5188  * Call this function when the hardware was restarted for some reason
5189  * (hardware error, ...) and the driver is unable to restore its state
5190  * by itself. mac80211 assumes that at this point the driver/hardware
5191  * is completely uninitialised and stopped, it starts the process by
5192  * calling the ->start() operation. The driver will need to reset all
5193  * internal state that it has prior to calling this function.
5194  *
5195  * @hw: the hardware to restart
5196  */
5197 void ieee80211_restart_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5198 
5199 /**
5200  * ieee80211_rx_list - receive frame and store processed skbs in a list
5201  *
5202  * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
5203  * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
5204  * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
5205  * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
5206  * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
5207  *
5208  * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5209  * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
5210  * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
5211  * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5212  * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5213  *
5214  * This function must be called with BHs disabled and RCU read lock
5215  *
5216  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5217  * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
5218  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5219  * @list: the destination list
5220  */
5221 void ieee80211_rx_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5222 		       struct sk_buff *skb, struct list_head *list);
5223 
5224 /**
5225  * ieee80211_rx_napi - receive frame from NAPI context
5226  *
5227  * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
5228  * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
5229  * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
5230  * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
5231  * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
5232  *
5233  * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5234  * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
5235  * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
5236  * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5237  * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5238  *
5239  * This function must be called with BHs disabled.
5240  *
5241  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5242  * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
5243  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5244  * @napi: the NAPI context
5245  */
5246 void ieee80211_rx_napi(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5247 		       struct sk_buff *skb, struct napi_struct *napi);
5248 
5249 /**
5250  * ieee80211_rx - receive frame
5251  *
5252  * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
5253  * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
5254  * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
5255  * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
5256  * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
5257  *
5258  * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5259  * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
5260  * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
5261  * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5262  * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5263  *
5264  * In process context use instead ieee80211_rx_ni().
5265  *
5266  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5267  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5268  */
5269 static inline void ieee80211_rx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb)
5270 {
5271 	ieee80211_rx_napi(hw, NULL, skb, NULL);
5272 }
5273 
5274 /**
5275  * ieee80211_rx_irqsafe - receive frame
5276  *
5277  * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in IRQ context
5278  * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
5279  *
5280  * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni() may not
5281  * be mixed for a single hardware.Must not run concurrently with
5282  * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5283  *
5284  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5285  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5286  */
5287 void ieee80211_rx_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
5288 
5289 /**
5290  * ieee80211_rx_ni - receive frame (in process context)
5291  *
5292  * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in process context
5293  * (internally disables bottom halves).
5294  *
5295  * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may
5296  * not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5297  * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5298  *
5299  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5300  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5301  */
5302 static inline void ieee80211_rx_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5303 				   struct sk_buff *skb)
5304 {
5305 	local_bh_disable();
5306 	ieee80211_rx(hw, skb);
5307 	local_bh_enable();
5308 }
5309 
5310 /**
5311  * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition - PS transition for connected sta
5312  *
5313  * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS
5314  * flag set, use this function to inform mac80211 about a connected station
5315  * entering/leaving PS mode.
5316  *
5317  * This function may not be called in IRQ context or with softirqs enabled.
5318  *
5319  * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized against
5320  * each other.
5321  *
5322  * @sta: currently connected sta
5323  * @start: start or stop PS
5324  *
5325  * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL when the requested PS mode is already set.
5326  */
5327 int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool start);
5328 
5329 /**
5330  * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni - PS transition for connected sta
5331  *                                  (in process context)
5332  *
5333  * Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() but can be called in process context
5334  * (internally disables bottom halves). Concurrent call restriction still
5335  * applies.
5336  *
5337  * @sta: currently connected sta
5338  * @start: start or stop PS
5339  *
5340  * Return: Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition().
5341  */
5342 static inline int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5343 						  bool start)
5344 {
5345 	int ret;
5346 
5347 	local_bh_disable();
5348 	ret = ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(sta, start);
5349 	local_bh_enable();
5350 
5351 	return ret;
5352 }
5353 
5354 /**
5355  * ieee80211_sta_pspoll - PS-Poll frame received
5356  * @sta: currently connected station
5357  *
5358  * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
5359  * use this function to inform mac80211 that a PS-Poll frame from a
5360  * connected station was received.
5361  * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
5362  * and possibly ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(); calls to all three must
5363  * be serialized.
5364  */
5365 void ieee80211_sta_pspoll(struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
5366 
5367 /**
5368  * ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger - (potential) U-APSD trigger frame received
5369  * @sta: currently connected station
5370  * @tid: TID of the received (potential) trigger frame
5371  *
5372  * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
5373  * use this function to inform mac80211 that a (potential) trigger frame
5374  * from a connected station was received.
5375  * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
5376  * and possibly ieee80211_sta_pspoll(); calls to all three must be
5377  * serialized.
5378  * %IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS can be passed as the tid if the tid is unknown.
5379  * In this case, mac80211 will not check that this tid maps to an AC
5380  * that is trigger enabled and assume that the caller did the proper
5381  * checks.
5382  */
5383 void ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
5384 
5385 /*
5386  * The TX headroom reserved by mac80211 for its own tx_status functions.
5387  * This is enough for the radiotap header.
5388  */
5389 #define IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_HEADROOM	ALIGN(14, 4)
5390 
5391 /**
5392  * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered - inform mac80211 about driver-buffered frames
5393  * @sta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer for the sleeping station
5394  * @tid: the TID that has buffered frames
5395  * @buffered: indicates whether or not frames are buffered for this TID
5396  *
5397  * If a driver buffers frames for a powersave station instead of passing
5398  * them back to mac80211 for retransmission, the station may still need
5399  * to be told that there are buffered frames via the TIM bit.
5400  *
5401  * This function informs mac80211 whether or not there are frames that are
5402  * buffered in the driver for a given TID; mac80211 can then use this data
5403  * to set the TIM bit (NOTE: This may call back into the driver's set_tim
5404  * call! Beware of the locking!)
5405  *
5406  * If all frames are released to the station (due to PS-poll or uAPSD)
5407  * then the driver needs to inform mac80211 that there no longer are
5408  * frames buffered. However, when the station wakes up mac80211 assumes
5409  * that all buffered frames will be transmitted and clears this data,
5410  * drivers need to make sure they inform mac80211 about all buffered
5411  * frames on the sleep transition (sta_notify() with %STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP).
5412  *
5413  * Note that technically mac80211 only needs to know this per AC, not per
5414  * TID, but since driver buffering will inevitably happen per TID (since
5415  * it is related to aggregation) it is easier to make mac80211 map the
5416  * TID to the AC as required instead of keeping track in all drivers that
5417  * use this API.
5418  */
5419 void ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5420 				u8 tid, bool buffered);
5421 
5422 /**
5423  * ieee80211_get_tx_rates - get the selected transmit rates for a packet
5424  *
5425  * Call this function in a driver with per-packet rate selection support
5426  * to combine the rate info in the packet tx info with the most recent
5427  * rate selection table for the station entry.
5428  *
5429  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5430  * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent.
5431  * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
5432  * @dest: buffer for extracted rate/retry information
5433  * @max_rates: maximum number of rates to fetch
5434  */
5435 void ieee80211_get_tx_rates(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5436 			    struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5437 			    struct sk_buff *skb,
5438 			    struct ieee80211_tx_rate *dest,
5439 			    int max_rates);
5440 
5441 /**
5442  * ieee80211_tx_rate_update - transmit rate update callback
5443  *
5444  * Drivers should call this functions with a non-NULL pub sta
5445  * This function can be used in drivers that does not have provision
5446  * in updating the tx rate in data path.
5447  *
5448  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5449  * @pubsta: the station to update the tx rate for.
5450  * @info: tx status information
5451  */
5452 void ieee80211_tx_rate_update(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5453 			      struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
5454 			      struct ieee80211_tx_info *info);
5455 
5456 /**
5457  * ieee80211_tx_status_skb - transmit status callback
5458  *
5459  * Call this function for all transmitted frames after they have been
5460  * transmitted. It is permissible to not call this function for
5461  * multicast frames but this can affect statistics.
5462  *
5463  * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5464  * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls
5465  * to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni() and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe()
5466  * may not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5467  * ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni().
5468  *
5469  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5470  * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5471  */
5472 void ieee80211_tx_status_skb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5473 			     struct sk_buff *skb);
5474 
5475 /**
5476  * ieee80211_tx_status_ext - extended transmit status callback
5477  *
5478  * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status_skb()
5479  * in drivers that may want to provide extra information that does not
5480  * fit into &struct ieee80211_tx_info.
5481  *
5482  * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
5483  * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
5484  * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5485  *
5486  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5487  * @status: tx status information
5488  */
5489 void ieee80211_tx_status_ext(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5490 			     struct ieee80211_tx_status *status);
5491 
5492 /**
5493  * ieee80211_tx_status_noskb - transmit status callback without skb
5494  *
5495  * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status_skb()
5496  * in drivers that cannot reliably map tx status information back to
5497  * specific skbs.
5498  *
5499  * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
5500  * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
5501  * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5502  *
5503  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5504  * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent
5505  *	(NULL for multicast packets)
5506  * @info: tx status information
5507  */
5508 static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_noskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5509 					     struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5510 					     struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
5511 {
5512 	struct ieee80211_tx_status status = {
5513 		.sta = sta,
5514 		.info = info,
5515 	};
5516 
5517 	ieee80211_tx_status_ext(hw, &status);
5518 }
5519 
5520 /**
5521  * ieee80211_tx_status_ni - transmit status callback (in process context)
5522  *
5523  * Like ieee80211_tx_status_skb() but can be called in process context.
5524  *
5525  * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_skb() and
5526  * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed
5527  * for a single hardware.
5528  *
5529  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5530  * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5531  */
5532 static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5533 					  struct sk_buff *skb)
5534 {
5535 	local_bh_disable();
5536 	ieee80211_tx_status_skb(hw, skb);
5537 	local_bh_enable();
5538 }
5539 
5540 /**
5541  * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe - IRQ-safe transmit status callback
5542  *
5543  * Like ieee80211_tx_status_skb() but can be called in IRQ context
5544  * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
5545  *
5546  * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_skb() and
5547  * ieee80211_tx_status_ni() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5548  *
5549  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5550  * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5551  */
5552 void ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5553 				 struct sk_buff *skb);
5554 
5555 /**
5556  * ieee80211_report_low_ack - report non-responding station
5557  *
5558  * When operating in AP-mode, call this function to report a non-responding
5559  * connected STA.
5560  *
5561  * @sta: the non-responding connected sta
5562  * @num_packets: number of packets sent to @sta without a response
5563  */
5564 void ieee80211_report_low_ack(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u32 num_packets);
5565 
5566 #define IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM 2
5567 
5568 /**
5569  * struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets - mutable beacon offsets
5570  * @tim_offset: position of TIM element
5571  * @tim_length: size of TIM element
5572  * @cntdwn_counter_offs: array of IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM offsets
5573  *	to countdown counters.  This array can contain zero values which
5574  *	should be ignored.
5575  * @mbssid_off: position of the multiple bssid element
5576  */
5577 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets {
5578 	u16 tim_offset;
5579 	u16 tim_length;
5580 
5581 	u16 cntdwn_counter_offs[IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM];
5582 	u16 mbssid_off;
5583 };
5584 
5585 /**
5586  * ieee80211_beacon_get_template - beacon template generation function
5587  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5588  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5589  * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5590  *	receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5591  * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
5592  *	that is not associated with AP MLD).
5593  *
5594  * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
5595  * obtain the beacon template.
5596  *
5597  * This function should be used if the beacon frames are generated by the
5598  * device, and then the driver must use the returned beacon as the template
5599  * The driver or the device are responsible to update the DTIM and, when
5600  * applicable, the CSA count.
5601  *
5602  * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
5603  *
5604  * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
5605  */
5606 struct sk_buff *
5607 ieee80211_beacon_get_template(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5608 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5609 			      struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs,
5610 			      unsigned int link_id);
5611 
5612 /**
5613  * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_index - EMA beacon template generation
5614  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5615  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5616  * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5617  *	receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5618  * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP).
5619  * @ema_index: index of the beacon in the EMA set.
5620  *
5621  * This function follows the same rules as ieee80211_beacon_get_template()
5622  * but returns a beacon template which includes multiple BSSID element at the
5623  * requested index.
5624  *
5625  * Return: The beacon template. %NULL indicates the end of EMA templates.
5626  */
5627 struct sk_buff *
5628 ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_index(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5629 					struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5630 					struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs,
5631 					unsigned int link_id, u8 ema_index);
5632 
5633 /**
5634  * struct ieee80211_ema_beacons - List of EMA beacons
5635  * @cnt: count of EMA beacons.
5636  *
5637  * @bcn: array of EMA beacons.
5638  * @bcn.skb: the skb containing this specific beacon
5639  * @bcn.offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5640  *	receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5641  */
5642 struct ieee80211_ema_beacons {
5643 	u8 cnt;
5644 	struct {
5645 		struct sk_buff *skb;
5646 		struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets offs;
5647 	} bcn[];
5648 };
5649 
5650 /**
5651  * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list - EMA beacon template generation
5652  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5653  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5654  * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP)
5655  *
5656  * This function follows the same rules as ieee80211_beacon_get_template()
5657  * but allocates and returns a pointer to list of all beacon templates required
5658  * to cover all profiles in the multiple BSSID set. Each template includes only
5659  * one multiple BSSID element.
5660  *
5661  * Driver must call ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list() to free the memory.
5662  *
5663  * Return: EMA beacon templates of type struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *.
5664  *	%NULL on error.
5665  */
5666 struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *
5667 ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5668 				       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5669 				       unsigned int link_id);
5670 
5671 /**
5672  * ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list - free an EMA beacon template list
5673  * @ema_beacons: list of EMA beacons of type &struct ieee80211_ema_beacons pointers.
5674  *
5675  * This function will free a list previously acquired by calling
5676  * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list()
5677  */
5678 void ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list(struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *ema_beacons);
5679 
5680 /**
5681  * ieee80211_beacon_get_tim - beacon generation function
5682  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5683  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5684  * @tim_offset: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE offset.
5685  *	Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
5686  * @tim_length: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE length,
5687  *	(including the ID and length bytes!).
5688  *	Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
5689  * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
5690  *	that is not associated with AP MLD).
5691  *
5692  * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
5693  * obtain the beacon frame.
5694  *
5695  * If the beacon frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5696  * hardware/firmware), the driver uses this function to get each beacon
5697  * frame from mac80211 -- it is responsible for calling this function exactly
5698  * once before the beacon is needed (e.g. based on hardware interrupt).
5699  *
5700  * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
5701  *
5702  * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
5703  */
5704 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5705 					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5706 					 u16 *tim_offset, u16 *tim_length,
5707 					 unsigned int link_id);
5708 
5709 /**
5710  * ieee80211_beacon_get - beacon generation function
5711  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5712  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5713  * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
5714  *	that is not associated with AP MLD).
5715  *
5716  * See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
5717  *
5718  * Return: See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
5719  */
5720 static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5721 						   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5722 						   unsigned int link_id)
5723 {
5724 	return ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(hw, vif, NULL, NULL, link_id);
5725 }
5726 
5727 /**
5728  * ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn - request mac80211 to decrement the beacon countdown
5729  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5730  * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
5731  *
5732  * The beacon counter should be updated after each beacon transmission.
5733  * This function is called implicitly when
5734  * ieee80211_beacon_get/ieee80211_beacon_get_tim are called, however if the
5735  * beacon frames are generated by the device, the driver should call this
5736  * function after each beacon transmission to sync mac80211's beacon countdown.
5737  *
5738  * Return: new countdown value
5739  */
5740 u8 ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5741 				  unsigned int link_id);
5742 
5743 /**
5744  * ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn - request mac80211 to set beacon countdown
5745  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5746  * @counter: the new value for the counter
5747  *
5748  * The beacon countdown can be changed by the device, this API should be
5749  * used by the device driver to update csa counter in mac80211.
5750  *
5751  * It should never be used together with ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(),
5752  * as it will cause a race condition around the counter value.
5753  */
5754 void ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 counter);
5755 
5756 /**
5757  * ieee80211_csa_finish - notify mac80211 about channel switch
5758  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5759  * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
5760  *
5761  * After a channel switch announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
5762  * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
5763  * notify mac80211 that the channel can be changed.
5764  */
5765 void ieee80211_csa_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id);
5766 
5767 /**
5768  * ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete - find out if countdown reached 1
5769  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5770  * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
5771  *
5772  * Return: %true if the countdown reached 1, %false otherwise
5773  */
5774 bool ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5775 					 unsigned int link_id);
5776 
5777 /**
5778  * ieee80211_color_change_finish - notify mac80211 about color change
5779  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5780  * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
5781  *
5782  * After a color change announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
5783  * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
5784  * notify mac80211 that the color can be changed
5785  */
5786 void ieee80211_color_change_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 link_id);
5787 
5788 /**
5789  * ieee80211_proberesp_get - retrieve a Probe Response template
5790  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5791  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5792  *
5793  * Creates a Probe Response template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5794  * hardware. The destination address should be set by the caller.
5795  *
5796  * Can only be called in AP mode.
5797  *
5798  * Return: The Probe Response template. %NULL on error.
5799  */
5800 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_proberesp_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5801 					struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5802 
5803 /**
5804  * ieee80211_pspoll_get - retrieve a PS Poll template
5805  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5806  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5807  *
5808  * Creates a PS Poll a template which can, for example, uploaded to
5809  * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
5810  * AID, BSSID and MAC address is used.
5811  *
5812  * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
5813  * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit.
5814  *
5815  * Return: The PS Poll template. %NULL on error.
5816  */
5817 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_pspoll_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5818 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5819 
5820 /**
5821  * ieee80211_nullfunc_get - retrieve a nullfunc template
5822  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5823  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5824  * @link_id: If the vif is an MLD, get a frame with the link addresses
5825  *	for the given link ID. For a link_id < 0 you get a frame with
5826  *	MLD addresses, however useful that might be.
5827  * @qos_ok: QoS NDP is acceptable to the caller, this should be set
5828  *	if at all possible
5829  *
5830  * Creates a Nullfunc template which can, for example, uploaded to
5831  * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
5832  * BSSID and address is used.
5833  *
5834  * If @qos_ndp is set and the association is to an AP with QoS/WMM, the
5835  * returned packet will be QoS NDP.
5836  *
5837  * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
5838  * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit as well as Duration and Sequence Control fields.
5839  *
5840  * Return: The nullfunc template. %NULL on error.
5841  */
5842 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_nullfunc_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5843 				       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5844 				       int link_id, bool qos_ok);
5845 
5846 /**
5847  * ieee80211_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
5848  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5849  * @src_addr: source MAC address
5850  * @ssid: SSID buffer
5851  * @ssid_len: length of SSID
5852  * @tailroom: tailroom to reserve at end of SKB for IEs
5853  *
5854  * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5855  * hardware.
5856  *
5857  * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
5858  */
5859 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5860 				       const u8 *src_addr,
5861 				       const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len,
5862 				       size_t tailroom);
5863 
5864 /**
5865  * ieee80211_rts_get - RTS frame generation function
5866  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5867  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5868  * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
5869  * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
5870  * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5871  * @rts: The buffer where to store the RTS frame.
5872  *
5873  * If the RTS frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5874  * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5875  * the next RTS frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
5876  * for calling this function before and RTS frame is needed.
5877  */
5878 void ieee80211_rts_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5879 		       const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
5880 		       const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
5881 		       struct ieee80211_rts *rts);
5882 
5883 /**
5884  * ieee80211_rts_duration - Get the duration field for an RTS frame
5885  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5886  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5887  * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
5888  * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5889  *
5890  * If the RTS is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
5891  * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5892  * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
5893  *
5894  * Return: The duration.
5895  */
5896 __le16 ieee80211_rts_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5897 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif, size_t frame_len,
5898 			      const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
5899 
5900 /**
5901  * ieee80211_ctstoself_get - CTS-to-self frame generation function
5902  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5903  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5904  * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
5905  * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
5906  * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5907  * @cts: The buffer where to store the CTS-to-self frame.
5908  *
5909  * If the CTS-to-self frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5910  * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5911  * the next CTS-to-self frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
5912  * for calling this function before and CTS-to-self frame is needed.
5913  */
5914 void ieee80211_ctstoself_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5915 			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5916 			     const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
5917 			     const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
5918 			     struct ieee80211_cts *cts);
5919 
5920 /**
5921  * ieee80211_ctstoself_duration - Get the duration field for a CTS-to-self frame
5922  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5923  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5924  * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
5925  * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5926  *
5927  * If the CTS-to-self is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
5928  * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5929  * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
5930  *
5931  * Return: The duration.
5932  */
5933 __le16 ieee80211_ctstoself_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5934 				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5935 				    size_t frame_len,
5936 				    const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
5937 
5938 /**
5939  * ieee80211_generic_frame_duration - Calculate the duration field for a frame
5940  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5941  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5942  * @band: the band to calculate the frame duration on
5943  * @frame_len: the length of the frame.
5944  * @rate: the rate at which the frame is going to be transmitted.
5945  *
5946  * Calculate the duration field of some generic frame, given its
5947  * length and transmission rate (in 100kbps).
5948  *
5949  * Return: The duration.
5950  */
5951 __le16 ieee80211_generic_frame_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5952 					struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5953 					enum nl80211_band band,
5954 					size_t frame_len,
5955 					struct ieee80211_rate *rate);
5956 
5957 /**
5958  * ieee80211_get_buffered_bc - accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames
5959  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5960  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5961  *
5962  * Function for accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames. If
5963  * hardware/firmware does not implement buffering of broadcast/multicast
5964  * frames when power saving is used, 802.11 code buffers them in the host
5965  * memory. The low-level driver uses this function to fetch next buffered
5966  * frame. In most cases, this is used when generating beacon frame.
5967  *
5968  * Return: A pointer to the next buffered skb or NULL if no more buffered
5969  * frames are available.
5970  *
5971  * Note: buffered frames are returned only after DTIM beacon frame was
5972  * generated with ieee80211_beacon_get() and the low-level driver must thus
5973  * call ieee80211_beacon_get() first. ieee80211_get_buffered_bc() returns
5974  * NULL if the previous generated beacon was not DTIM, so the low-level driver
5975  * does not need to check for DTIM beacons separately and should be able to
5976  * use common code for all beacons.
5977  */
5978 struct sk_buff *
5979 ieee80211_get_buffered_bc(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5980 
5981 /**
5982  * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv - get a TKIP phase 1 key for IV32
5983  *
5984  * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32.
5985  *
5986  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5987  * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
5988  * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5989  */
5990 void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5991 			       u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
5992 
5993 /**
5994  * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key
5995  *
5996  * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the IV32 taken
5997  * from the given packet.
5998  *
5999  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
6000  * @skb: the packet to take the IV32 value from that will be encrypted
6001  *	with this P1K
6002  * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
6003  */
6004 static inline void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
6005 					  struct sk_buff *skb, u16 *p1k)
6006 {
6007 	struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (struct ieee80211_hdr *)skb->data;
6008 	const u8 *data = (u8 *)hdr + ieee80211_hdrlen(hdr->frame_control);
6009 	u32 iv32 = get_unaligned_le32(&data[4]);
6010 
6011 	ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(keyconf, iv32, p1k);
6012 }
6013 
6014 /**
6015  * ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key for RX
6016  *
6017  * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32
6018  * and transmitter address.
6019  *
6020  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
6021  * @ta: TA that will be used with the key
6022  * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
6023  * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
6024  */
6025 void ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
6026 			       const u8 *ta, u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
6027 
6028 /**
6029  * ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k - get a TKIP phase 2 key
6030  *
6031  * This function computes the TKIP RC4 key for the IV values
6032  * in the packet.
6033  *
6034  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
6035  * @skb: the packet to take the IV32/IV16 values from that will be
6036  *	encrypted with this key
6037  * @p2k: a buffer to which the key will be written, 16 bytes
6038  */
6039 void ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
6040 			    struct sk_buff *skb, u8 *p2k);
6041 
6042 /**
6043  * ieee80211_tkip_add_iv - write TKIP IV and Ext. IV to pos
6044  *
6045  * @pos: start of crypto header
6046  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
6047  * @pn: PN to add
6048  *
6049  * Returns: pointer to the octet following IVs (i.e. beginning of
6050  * the packet payload)
6051  *
6052  * This function writes the tkip IV value to pos (which should
6053  * point to the crypto header)
6054  */
6055 u8 *ieee80211_tkip_add_iv(u8 *pos, struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, u64 pn);
6056 
6057 /**
6058  * ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq - get key RX sequence counter
6059  *
6060  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
6061  * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
6062  *	the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
6063  *	CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
6064  * @seq: buffer to receive the sequence data
6065  *
6066  * This function allows a driver to retrieve the current RX IV/PNs
6067  * for the given key. It must not be called if IV checking is done
6068  * by the device and not by mac80211.
6069  *
6070  * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
6071  * can be done concurrently.
6072  */
6073 void ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
6074 			      int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
6075 
6076 /**
6077  * ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq - set key RX sequence counter
6078  *
6079  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
6080  * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
6081  *	the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
6082  *	CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
6083  * @seq: new sequence data
6084  *
6085  * This function allows a driver to set the current RX IV/PNs for the
6086  * given key. This is useful when resuming from WoWLAN sleep and GTK
6087  * rekey may have been done while suspended. It should not be called
6088  * if IV checking is done by the device and not by mac80211.
6089  *
6090  * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
6091  * can be done concurrently.
6092  */
6093 void ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
6094 			      int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
6095 
6096 /**
6097  * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add - add a GTK key from rekeying during WoWLAN
6098  * @vif: the virtual interface to add the key on
6099  * @idx: the keyidx of the key
6100  * @key_data: the key data
6101  * @key_len: the key data. Might be bigger than the actual key length,
6102  *	but not smaller (for the driver convinence)
6103  * @link_id: the link id of the key or -1 for non-MLO
6104  *
6105  * When GTK rekeying was done while the system was suspended, (a) new
6106  * key(s) will be available. These will be needed by mac80211 for proper
6107  * RX processing, so this function allows setting them.
6108  *
6109  * Return: the newly allocated key structure, which will have
6110  * similar contents to the passed key configuration but point to
6111  * mac80211-owned memory. In case of errors, the function returns an
6112  * ERR_PTR(), use IS_ERR() etc.
6113  *
6114  * Note that this function assumes the key isn't added to hardware
6115  * acceleration, so no TX will be done with the key. Since it's a GTK
6116  * on managed (station) networks, this is true anyway. If the driver
6117  * calls this function from the resume callback and subsequently uses
6118  * the return code 1 to reconfigure the device, this key will be part
6119  * of the reconfiguration.
6120  *
6121  * Note that the driver should also call ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq()
6122  * for the new key for each TID to set up sequence counters properly.
6123  *
6124  * IMPORTANT: If this replaces a key that is present in the hardware,
6125  * then it will attempt to remove it during this call.
6126  */
6127 struct ieee80211_key_conf *
6128 ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6129 			u8 idx, u8 *key_data, u8 key_len,
6130 			int link_id);
6131 
6132 /**
6133  * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace supplicant of rekeying
6134  * @vif: virtual interface the rekeying was done on
6135  * @bssid: The BSSID of the AP, for checking association
6136  * @replay_ctr: the new replay counter after GTK rekeying
6137  * @gfp: allocation flags
6138  */
6139 void ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *bssid,
6140 				const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp);
6141 
6142 /**
6143  * ieee80211_key_mic_failure - increment MIC failure counter for the key
6144  *
6145  * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called
6146  * at the same time.
6147  *
6148  * @keyconf: the key in question
6149  */
6150 void ieee80211_key_mic_failure(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
6151 
6152 /**
6153  * ieee80211_key_replay - increment replay counter for the key
6154  *
6155  * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called
6156  * at the same time.
6157  *
6158  * @keyconf: the key in question
6159  */
6160 void ieee80211_key_replay(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
6161 
6162 /**
6163  * ieee80211_wake_queue - wake specific queue
6164  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6165  * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
6166  *
6167  * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_wake_queue.
6168  */
6169 void ieee80211_wake_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
6170 
6171 /**
6172  * ieee80211_stop_queue - stop specific queue
6173  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6174  * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
6175  *
6176  * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_stop_queue.
6177  */
6178 void ieee80211_stop_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
6179 
6180 /**
6181  * ieee80211_queue_stopped - test status of the queue
6182  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6183  * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
6184  *
6185  * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_queue_stopped.
6186  *
6187  * Return: %true if the queue is stopped. %false otherwise.
6188  */
6189 
6190 int ieee80211_queue_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
6191 
6192 /**
6193  * ieee80211_stop_queues - stop all queues
6194  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6195  *
6196  * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_stop_all_queues.
6197  */
6198 void ieee80211_stop_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6199 
6200 /**
6201  * ieee80211_wake_queues - wake all queues
6202  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6203  *
6204  * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_wake_all_queues.
6205  */
6206 void ieee80211_wake_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6207 
6208 /**
6209  * ieee80211_scan_completed - completed hardware scan
6210  *
6211  * When hardware scan offload is used (i.e. the hw_scan() callback is
6212  * assigned) this function needs to be called by the driver to notify
6213  * mac80211 that the scan finished. This function can be called from
6214  * any context, including hardirq context.
6215  *
6216  * @hw: the hardware that finished the scan
6217  * @info: information about the completed scan
6218  */
6219 void ieee80211_scan_completed(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6220 			      struct cfg80211_scan_info *info);
6221 
6222 /**
6223  * ieee80211_sched_scan_results - got results from scheduled scan
6224  *
6225  * When a scheduled scan is running, this function needs to be called by the
6226  * driver whenever there are new scan results available.
6227  *
6228  * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
6229  */
6230 void ieee80211_sched_scan_results(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6231 
6232 /**
6233  * ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped - inform that the scheduled scan has stopped
6234  *
6235  * When a scheduled scan is running, this function can be called by
6236  * the driver if it needs to stop the scan to perform another task.
6237  * Usual scenarios are drivers that cannot continue the scheduled scan
6238  * while associating, for instance.
6239  *
6240  * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
6241  */
6242 void ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6243 
6244 /**
6245  * enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags - interface iteration flags
6246  * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL: Iterate over all interfaces that have
6247  *	been added to the driver; However, note that during hardware
6248  *	reconfiguration (after restart_hw) it will iterate over a new
6249  *	interface and over all the existing interfaces even if they
6250  *	haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
6251  * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL: During resume, iterate over all
6252  *	interfaces, even if they haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
6253  * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE: Iterate only active interfaces (netdev is up).
6254  * @IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER: Skip any interfaces where SDATA
6255  *	is not in the driver.  This may fix crashes during firmware recovery
6256  *	for instance.
6257  */
6258 enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags {
6259 	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL	= 0,
6260 	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL	= BIT(0),
6261 	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE	= BIT(1),
6262 	IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER	= BIT(2),
6263 };
6264 
6265 /**
6266  * ieee80211_iterate_interfaces - iterate interfaces
6267  *
6268  * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6269  * hardware and calls the callback for them. This includes active as well as
6270  * inactive interfaces. This function allows the iterator function to sleep.
6271  * Will iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
6272  *
6273  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6274  * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6275  * @iterator: the iterator function to call
6276  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6277  */
6278 void ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
6279 				  void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
6280 						   struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6281 				  void *data);
6282 
6283 /**
6284  * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces - iterate active interfaces
6285  *
6286  * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6287  * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
6288  * This function allows the iterator function to sleep, when the iterator
6289  * function is atomic @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic can
6290  * be used.
6291  * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
6292  *
6293  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6294  * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6295  * @iterator: the iterator function to call
6296  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6297  */
6298 static inline void
6299 ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
6300 				    void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
6301 						     struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6302 				    void *data)
6303 {
6304 	ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(hw,
6305 				     iter_flags | IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE,
6306 				     iterator, data);
6307 }
6308 
6309 /**
6310  * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic - iterate active interfaces
6311  *
6312  * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6313  * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
6314  * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
6315  * if that is not desired, use @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces instead.
6316  * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
6317  *
6318  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6319  * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6320  * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6321  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6322  */
6323 void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6324 						u32 iter_flags,
6325 						void (*iterator)(void *data,
6326 						    u8 *mac,
6327 						    struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6328 						void *data);
6329 
6330 struct ieee80211_vif *
6331 __ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6332 			       struct ieee80211_vif *prev,
6333 			       u32 iter_flags);
6334 
6335 /**
6336  * for_each_interface - iterate interfaces under wiphy mutex
6337  * @vif: the iterator variable
6338  * @hw: the HW to iterate for
6339  * @flags: the iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6340  */
6341 #define for_each_interface(vif, hw, flags)				\
6342 	for (vif = __ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(hw, NULL, flags);	\
6343 	     vif;							\
6344 	     vif = __ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(hw, vif, flags))
6345 
6346 /**
6347  * for_each_active_interface - iterate active interfaces under wiphy mutex
6348  * @vif: the iterator variable
6349  * @hw: the HW to iterate for
6350  */
6351 #define for_each_active_interface(vif, hw)				\
6352 	for_each_interface(vif, hw, IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE)
6353 
6354 /**
6355  * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx - iterate active interfaces
6356  *
6357  * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6358  * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
6359  * This version can only be used while holding the wiphy mutex.
6360  *
6361  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6362  * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6363  * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6364  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6365  */
6366 static inline void
6367 ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6368 					u32 iter_flags,
6369 					void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
6370 							 struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6371 					void *data)
6372 {
6373 	struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
6374 
6375 	for_each_interface(vif, hw, iter_flags | IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE)
6376 		iterator(data, vif->addr, vif);
6377 }
6378 
6379 /**
6380  * ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic - iterate stations
6381  *
6382  * This function iterates over all stations associated with a given
6383  * hardware that are currently uploaded to the driver and calls the callback
6384  * function for them.
6385  * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
6386  *
6387  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6388  * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6389  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6390  */
6391 void ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6392 				       void (*iterator)(void *data,
6393 						struct ieee80211_sta *sta),
6394 				       void *data);
6395 
6396 struct ieee80211_sta *
6397 __ieee80211_iterate_stations(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6398 			     struct ieee80211_sta *prev);
6399 
6400 /**
6401  * for_each_station - iterate stations under wiphy mutex
6402  * @sta: the iterator variable
6403  * @hw: the HW to iterate for
6404  */
6405 #define for_each_station(sta, hw)					\
6406 	for (sta = __ieee80211_iterate_stations(hw, NULL);		\
6407 	     sta;							\
6408 	     sta = __ieee80211_iterate_stations(hw, sta))
6409 
6410 /**
6411  * ieee80211_iterate_stations_mtx - iterate stations
6412  *
6413  * This function iterates over all stations associated with a given
6414  * hardware that are currently uploaded to the driver and calls the callback
6415  * function for them. This version can only be used while holding the wiphy
6416  * mutex.
6417  *
6418  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6419  * @iterator: the iterator function to call
6420  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6421  */
6422 static inline void
6423 ieee80211_iterate_stations_mtx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6424 			       void (*iterator)(void *data,
6425 						struct ieee80211_sta *sta),
6426 			       void *data)
6427 {
6428 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
6429 
6430 	for_each_station(sta, hw)
6431 		iterator(data, sta);
6432 }
6433 
6434 /**
6435  * ieee80211_queue_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
6436  *
6437  * Drivers and mac80211 use this to add work onto the mac80211 workqueue.
6438  * This helper ensures drivers are not queueing work when they should not be.
6439  *
6440  * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
6441  * @work: the work we want to add onto the mac80211 workqueue
6442  */
6443 void ieee80211_queue_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct work_struct *work);
6444 
6445 /**
6446  * ieee80211_queue_delayed_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
6447  *
6448  * Drivers and mac80211 use this to queue delayed work onto the mac80211
6449  * workqueue.
6450  *
6451  * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
6452  * @dwork: delayable work to queue onto the mac80211 workqueue
6453  * @delay: number of jiffies to wait before queueing
6454  */
6455 void ieee80211_queue_delayed_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6456 				  struct delayed_work *dwork,
6457 				  unsigned long delay);
6458 
6459 /**
6460  * ieee80211_refresh_tx_agg_session_timer - Refresh a tx agg session timer.
6461  * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session
6462  * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6463  *
6464  * This function allows low level driver to refresh tx agg session timer
6465  * to maintain BA session, the session level will still be managed by the
6466  * mac80211.
6467  *
6468  * Note: must be called in an RCU critical section.
6469  */
6470 void ieee80211_refresh_tx_agg_session_timer(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6471 					    u16 tid);
6472 
6473 /**
6474  * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session - Start a tx Block Ack session.
6475  * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session
6476  * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6477  * @timeout: session timeout value (in TUs)
6478  *
6479  * Return: success if addBA request was sent, failure otherwise
6480  *
6481  * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
6482  * the need to start aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
6483  * will be managed by the mac80211.
6484  */
6485 int ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid,
6486 				  u16 timeout);
6487 
6488 /**
6489  * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to aggregate.
6490  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6491  * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
6492  * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6493  *
6494  * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
6495  * finished with preparations for the BA session. It can be called
6496  * from any context.
6497  */
6498 void ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
6499 				      u16 tid);
6500 
6501 /**
6502  * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session - Stop a Block Ack session.
6503  * @sta: the station whose BA session to stop
6504  * @tid: the TID to stop BA.
6505  *
6506  * Return: negative error if the TID is invalid, or no aggregation active
6507  *
6508  * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
6509  * the need to stop aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
6510  * will be managed by the mac80211.
6511  */
6512 int ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid);
6513 
6514 /**
6515  * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to stop aggregate.
6516  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6517  * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
6518  * @tid: the desired TID to BA on.
6519  *
6520  * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
6521  * finished with preparations for the BA session tear down. It
6522  * can be called from any context.
6523  */
6524 void ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
6525 				     u16 tid);
6526 
6527 /**
6528  * ieee80211_find_sta - find a station
6529  *
6530  * @vif: virtual interface to look for station on
6531  * @addr: station's address
6532  *
6533  * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
6534  *
6535  * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
6536  * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
6537  */
6538 struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6539 					 const u8 *addr);
6540 
6541 /**
6542  * ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr - find a station on hardware
6543  *
6544  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6545  * @addr: remote station's address
6546  * @localaddr: local address (vif->sdata->vif.addr). Use NULL for 'any'.
6547  *
6548  * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
6549  *
6550  * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
6551  * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
6552  *
6553  * NOTE: You may pass NULL for localaddr, but then you will just get
6554  *      the first STA that matches the remote address 'addr'.
6555  *      We can have multiple STA associated with multiple
6556  *      logical stations (e.g. consider a station connecting to another
6557  *      BSSID on the same AP hardware without disconnecting first).
6558  *      In this case, the result of this method with localaddr NULL
6559  *      is not reliable.
6560  *
6561  * DO NOT USE THIS FUNCTION with localaddr NULL if at all possible.
6562  */
6563 struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6564 					       const u8 *addr,
6565 					       const u8 *localaddr);
6566 
6567 /**
6568  * ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs - find STA by link addresses
6569  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6570  * @addr: remote station's link address
6571  * @localaddr: local link address, use %NULL for any (but avoid that)
6572  * @link_id: pointer to obtain the link ID if the STA is found,
6573  *	may be %NULL if the link ID is not needed
6574  *
6575  * Obtain the STA by link address, must use RCU protection.
6576  *
6577  * Return: pointer to STA if found, otherwise %NULL.
6578  */
6579 struct ieee80211_sta *
6580 ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6581 				 const u8 *addr,
6582 				 const u8 *localaddr,
6583 				 unsigned int *link_id);
6584 
6585 /**
6586  * ieee80211_sta_block_awake - block station from waking up
6587  * @hw: the hardware
6588  * @pubsta: the station
6589  * @block: whether to block or unblock
6590  *
6591  * Some devices require that all frames that are on the queues
6592  * for a specific station that went to sleep are flushed before
6593  * a poll response or frames after the station woke up can be
6594  * delivered to that it. Note that such frames must be rejected
6595  * by the driver as filtered, with the appropriate status flag.
6596  *
6597  * This function allows implementing this mode in a race-free
6598  * manner.
6599  *
6600  * To do this, a driver must keep track of the number of frames
6601  * still enqueued for a specific station. If this number is not
6602  * zero when the station goes to sleep, the driver must call
6603  * this function to force mac80211 to consider the station to
6604  * be asleep regardless of the station's actual state. Once the
6605  * number of outstanding frames reaches zero, the driver must
6606  * call this function again to unblock the station. That will
6607  * cause mac80211 to be able to send ps-poll responses, and if
6608  * the station queried in the meantime then frames will also
6609  * be sent out as a result of this. Additionally, the driver
6610  * will be notified that the station woke up some time after
6611  * it is unblocked, regardless of whether the station actually
6612  * woke up while blocked or not.
6613  */
6614 void ieee80211_sta_block_awake(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6615 			       struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, bool block);
6616 
6617 /**
6618  * ieee80211_sta_eosp - notify mac80211 about end of SP
6619  * @pubsta: the station
6620  *
6621  * When a device transmits frames in a way that it can't tell
6622  * mac80211 in the TX status about the EOSP, it must clear the
6623  * %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP bit and call this function instead.
6624  * This applies for PS-Poll as well as uAPSD.
6625  *
6626  * Note that just like with _tx_status() and _rx() drivers must
6627  * not mix calls to irqsafe/non-irqsafe versions, this function
6628  * must not be mixed with those either. Use the all irqsafe, or
6629  * all non-irqsafe, don't mix!
6630  *
6631  * NB: the _irqsafe version of this function doesn't exist, no
6632  *     driver needs it right now. Don't call this function if
6633  *     you'd need the _irqsafe version, look at the git history
6634  *     and restore the _irqsafe version!
6635  */
6636 void ieee80211_sta_eosp(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
6637 
6638 /**
6639  * ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc - ask mac80211 to send NDP with EOSP
6640  * @pubsta: the station
6641  * @tid: the tid of the NDP
6642  *
6643  * Sometimes the device understands that it needs to close
6644  * the Service Period unexpectedly. This can happen when
6645  * sending frames that are filling holes in the BA window.
6646  * In this case, the device can ask mac80211 to send a
6647  * Nullfunc frame with EOSP set. When that happens, the
6648  * driver must have called ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() to
6649  * let mac80211 know that there are no buffered frames any
6650  * more, otherwise mac80211 will get the more_data bit wrong.
6651  * The low level driver must have made sure that the frame
6652  * will be sent despite the station being in power-save.
6653  * Mac80211 won't call allow_buffered_frames().
6654  * Note that calling this function, doesn't exempt the driver
6655  * from closing the EOSP properly, it will still have to call
6656  * ieee80211_sta_eosp when the NDP is sent.
6657  */
6658 void ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, int tid);
6659 
6660 /**
6661  * ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates - recalculate aggregate data after a change
6662  * @pubsta: the station
6663  *
6664  * Call this function after changing a per-link aggregate data as referenced in
6665  * &struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates by accessing the agg field of
6666  * &struct ieee80211_link_sta.
6667  *
6668  * With non MLO the data in deflink will be referenced directly. In that case
6669  * there is no need to call this function.
6670  */
6671 void ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
6672 
6673 /**
6674  * ieee80211_sta_register_airtime - register airtime usage for a sta/tid
6675  *
6676  * Register airtime usage for a given sta on a given tid. The driver must call
6677  * this function to notify mac80211 that a station used a certain amount of
6678  * airtime. This information will be used by the TXQ scheduler to schedule
6679  * stations in a way that ensures airtime fairness.
6680  *
6681  * The reported airtime should as a minimum include all time that is spent
6682  * transmitting to the remote station, including overhead and padding, but not
6683  * including time spent waiting for a TXOP. If the time is not reported by the
6684  * hardware it can in some cases be calculated from the rate and known frame
6685  * composition. When possible, the time should include any failed transmission
6686  * attempts.
6687  *
6688  * The driver can either call this function synchronously for every packet or
6689  * aggregate, or asynchronously as airtime usage information becomes available.
6690  * TX and RX airtime can be reported together, or separately by setting one of
6691  * them to 0.
6692  *
6693  * @pubsta: the station
6694  * @tid: the TID to register airtime for
6695  * @tx_airtime: airtime used during TX (in usec)
6696  * @rx_airtime: airtime used during RX (in usec)
6697  */
6698 void ieee80211_sta_register_airtime(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
6699 				    u32 tx_airtime, u32 rx_airtime);
6700 
6701 /**
6702  * ieee80211_txq_airtime_check - check if a txq can send frame to device
6703  *
6704  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6705  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
6706  *
6707  * Return: %true if the AQL's airtime limit has not been reached and the txq can
6708  * continue to send more packets to the device. Otherwise return %false.
6709  */
6710 bool
6711 ieee80211_txq_airtime_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
6712 
6713 /**
6714  * ieee80211_iter_keys - iterate keys programmed into the device
6715  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6716  * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
6717  * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
6718  * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
6719  *
6720  * Context: Must be called with wiphy mutex held; can sleep.
6721  *
6722  * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
6723  * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
6724  * the device. This is intended for use in WoWLAN if the device
6725  * needs reprogramming of the keys during suspend.
6726  *
6727  * The order in which the keys are iterated matches the order
6728  * in which they were originally installed and handed to the
6729  * set_key callback.
6730  */
6731 void ieee80211_iter_keys(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6732 			 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6733 			 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6734 				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6735 				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6736 				      struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
6737 				      void *data),
6738 			 void *iter_data);
6739 
6740 /**
6741  * ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu - iterate keys programmed into the device
6742  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6743  * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
6744  * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
6745  * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
6746  *
6747  * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
6748  * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
6749  * the device. Note that due to locking reasons, keys of station
6750  * in removal process will be skipped.
6751  *
6752  * This function requires being called in an RCU critical section,
6753  * and thus iter must be atomic.
6754  */
6755 void ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6756 			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6757 			     void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6758 					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6759 					  struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6760 					  struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
6761 					  void *data),
6762 			     void *iter_data);
6763 
6764 /**
6765  * ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic - iterate channel contexts
6766  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6767  * @iter: iterator function
6768  * @iter_data: data passed to iterator function
6769  *
6770  * Iterate all active channel contexts. This function is atomic and
6771  * doesn't acquire any locks internally that might be held in other
6772  * places while calling into the driver.
6773  *
6774  * The iterator will not find a context that's being added (during
6775  * the driver callback to add it) but will find it while it's being
6776  * removed.
6777  *
6778  * Note that during hardware restart, all contexts that existed
6779  * before the restart are considered already present so will be
6780  * found while iterating, whether they've been re-added already
6781  * or not.
6782  */
6783 void ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic(
6784 	struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6785 	void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6786 		     struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf,
6787 		     void *data),
6788 	void *iter_data);
6789 
6790 /**
6791  * ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_mtx - iterate channel contexts
6792  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6793  * @iter: iterator function
6794  * @iter_data: data passed to iterator function
6795  *
6796  * Iterate all active channel contexts. This function can only be used while
6797  * holding the wiphy mutex.
6798  *
6799  * The iterator will not find a context that's being added (during
6800  * the driver callback to add it) but will find it while it's being
6801  * removed.
6802  *
6803  * Note that during hardware restart, all contexts that existed
6804  * before the restart are considered already present so will be
6805  * found while iterating, whether they've been re-added already
6806  * or not.
6807  */
6808 void ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_mtx(
6809 	struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6810 	void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6811 		     struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf,
6812 		     void *data),
6813 	void *iter_data);
6814 
6815 /**
6816  * ieee80211_ap_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
6817  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6818  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6819  *
6820  * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
6821  * hardware. The template is filled with bssid, ssid and supported rate
6822  * information. This function must only be called from within the
6823  * .bss_info_changed callback function and only in managed mode. The function
6824  * is only useful when the interface is associated, otherwise it will return
6825  * %NULL.
6826  *
6827  * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
6828  */
6829 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_ap_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6830 					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6831 
6832 /**
6833  * ieee80211_beacon_loss - inform hardware does not receive beacons
6834  *
6835  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6836  *
6837  * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER and
6838  * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set, the driver needs to inform whenever the
6839  * hardware is not receiving beacons with this function.
6840  */
6841 void ieee80211_beacon_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6842 
6843 /**
6844  * ieee80211_connection_loss - inform hardware has lost connection to the AP
6845  *
6846  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6847  *
6848  * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER, and
6849  * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS and %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR are set, the driver
6850  * needs to inform if the connection to the AP has been lost.
6851  * The function may also be called if the connection needs to be terminated
6852  * for some other reason, even if %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR isn't set.
6853  *
6854  * This function will cause immediate change to disassociated state,
6855  * without connection recovery attempts.
6856  */
6857 void ieee80211_connection_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6858 
6859 /**
6860  * ieee80211_disconnect - request disconnection
6861  *
6862  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6863  * @reconnect: immediate reconnect is desired
6864  *
6865  * Request disconnection from the current network and, if enabled, send a
6866  * hint to the higher layers that immediate reconnect is desired.
6867  */
6868 void ieee80211_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool reconnect);
6869 
6870 /**
6871  * ieee80211_resume_disconnect - disconnect from AP after resume
6872  *
6873  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6874  *
6875  * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after resume.
6876  * Drivers can use this after WoWLAN if they know that the
6877  * connection cannot be kept up, for example because keys were
6878  * used while the device was asleep but the replay counters or
6879  * similar cannot be retrieved from the device during resume.
6880  *
6881  * Note that due to implementation issues, if the driver uses
6882  * the reconfiguration functionality during resume the interface
6883  * will still be added as associated first during resume and then
6884  * disconnect normally later.
6885  *
6886  * This function can only be called from the resume callback and
6887  * the driver must not be holding any of its own locks while it
6888  * calls this function, or at least not any locks it needs in the
6889  * key configuration paths (if it supports HW crypto).
6890  */
6891 void ieee80211_resume_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6892 
6893 /**
6894  * ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect - disconnect from AP after
6895  * hardware restart
6896  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6897  *
6898  * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after
6899  * hardware restart.
6900  */
6901 void ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6902 
6903 /**
6904  * ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify - inform a configured connection quality monitoring
6905  *	rssi threshold triggered
6906  *
6907  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6908  * @rssi_event: the RSSI trigger event type
6909  * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available
6910  * @gfp: context flags
6911  *
6912  * When the %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI is set, and a connection quality
6913  * monitoring is configured with an rssi threshold, the driver will inform
6914  * whenever the rssi level reaches the threshold.
6915  */
6916 void ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6917 			       enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event,
6918 			       s32 rssi_level,
6919 			       gfp_t gfp);
6920 
6921 /**
6922  * ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - inform CQM of beacon loss
6923  *
6924  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6925  * @gfp: context flags
6926  */
6927 void ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, gfp_t gfp);
6928 
6929 /**
6930  * ieee80211_radar_detected - inform that a radar was detected
6931  *
6932  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6933  * @chanctx_conf: Channel context on which radar is detected. Mandatory to
6934  *	pass a valid pointer during MLO. For non-MLO %NULL can be passed
6935  */
6936 void ieee80211_radar_detected(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6937 			      struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf);
6938 
6939 /**
6940  * ieee80211_chswitch_done - Complete channel switch process
6941  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6942  * @success: make the channel switch successful or not
6943  * @link_id: the link_id on which the switch was done. Ignored if success is
6944  *	false.
6945  *
6946  * Complete the channel switch post-process: set the new operational channel
6947  * and wake up the suspended queues.
6948  */
6949 void ieee80211_chswitch_done(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool success,
6950 			     unsigned int link_id);
6951 
6952 /**
6953  * ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect - disconnect due to channel switch error
6954  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6955  *
6956  * Instruct mac80211 to disconnect due to a channel switch error. The channel
6957  * switch can request to block the tx and so, we need to make sure we do not send
6958  * a deauth frame in this case.
6959  */
6960 void ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6961 
6962 /**
6963  * ieee80211_request_smps - request SM PS transition
6964  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6965  * @link_id: link ID for MLO, or 0
6966  * @smps_mode: new SM PS mode
6967  *
6968  * This allows the driver to request an SM PS transition in managed
6969  * mode. This is useful when the driver has more information than
6970  * the stack about possible interference, for example by bluetooth.
6971  */
6972 void ieee80211_request_smps(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id,
6973 			    enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode);
6974 
6975 /**
6976  * ieee80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain-on-channel start
6977  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6978  */
6979 void ieee80211_ready_on_channel(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6980 
6981 /**
6982  * ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired
6983  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6984  */
6985 void ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6986 
6987 /**
6988  * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session - callback to stop existing BA sessions
6989  *
6990  * in order not to harm the system performance and user experience, the device
6991  * may request not to allow any rx ba session and tear down existing rx ba
6992  * sessions based on system constraints such as periodic BT activity that needs
6993  * to limit wlan activity (eg.sco or a2dp)."
6994  * in such cases, the intention is to limit the duration of the rx ppdu and
6995  * therefore prevent the peer device to use a-mpdu aggregation.
6996  *
6997  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6998  * @ba_rx_bitmap: Bit map of open rx ba per tid
6999  * @addr: & to bssid mac address
7000  */
7001 void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 ba_rx_bitmap,
7002 				  const u8 *addr);
7003 
7004 /**
7005  * ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames - move RX BA window and mark filtered
7006  * @pubsta: station struct
7007  * @tid: the session's TID
7008  * @ssn: starting sequence number of the bitmap, all frames before this are
7009  *	assumed to be out of the window after the call
7010  * @filtered: bitmap of filtered frames, BIT(0) is the @ssn entry etc.
7011  * @received_mpdus: number of received mpdus in firmware
7012  *
7013  * This function moves the BA window and releases all frames before @ssn, and
7014  * marks frames marked in the bitmap as having been filtered. Afterwards, it
7015  * checks if any frames in the window starting from @ssn can now be released
7016  * (in case they were only waiting for frames that were filtered.)
7017  * (Only work correctly if @max_rx_aggregation_subframes <= 64 frames)
7018  */
7019 void ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
7020 					  u16 ssn, u64 filtered,
7021 					  u16 received_mpdus);
7022 
7023 /**
7024  * ieee80211_send_bar - send a BlockAckReq frame
7025  *
7026  * can be used to flush pending frames from the peer's aggregation reorder
7027  * buffer.
7028  *
7029  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7030  * @ra: the peer's destination address
7031  * @tid: the TID of the aggregation session
7032  * @ssn: the new starting sequence number for the receiver
7033  */
7034 void ieee80211_send_bar(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 *ra, u16 tid, u16 ssn);
7035 
7036 /**
7037  * ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl - helper to queue an RX BA work
7038  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
7039  * @addr: station mac address
7040  * @tid: the rx tid
7041  */
7042 void ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *addr,
7043 				 unsigned int tid);
7044 
7045 /**
7046  * ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl - start a Rx BA session
7047  *
7048  * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
7049  * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
7050  * reordering.
7051  *
7052  * Create structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
7053  * when they complete AddBa negotiation.
7054  *
7055  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
7056  * @addr: station mac address
7057  * @tid: the rx tid
7058  */
7059 static inline void ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7060 						      const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
7061 {
7062 	if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
7063 		return;
7064 	ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid);
7065 }
7066 
7067 /**
7068  * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl - stop a Rx BA session
7069  *
7070  * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
7071  * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
7072  * reordering.
7073  *
7074  * Destroy structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
7075  * when they complete DelBa negotiation.
7076  *
7077  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
7078  * @addr: station mac address
7079  * @tid: the rx tid
7080  */
7081 static inline void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7082 						     const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
7083 {
7084 	if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
7085 		return;
7086 	ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid + IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS);
7087 }
7088 
7089 /**
7090  * ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired - stop a Rx BA session due to timeout
7091  *
7092  * Some device drivers do not offload AddBa/DelBa negotiation, but handle rx
7093  * buffer reording internally, and therefore also handle the session timer.
7094  *
7095  * Trigger the timeout flow, which sends a DelBa.
7096  *
7097  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
7098  * @addr: station mac address
7099  * @tid: the rx tid
7100  */
7101 void ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7102 				   const u8 *addr, unsigned int tid);
7103 
7104 /* Rate control API */
7105 
7106 /**
7107  * struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control - rate control information for/from RC algo
7108  *
7109  * @hw: The hardware the algorithm is invoked for.
7110  * @sband: The band this frame is being transmitted on.
7111  * @bss_conf: the current BSS configuration
7112  * @skb: the skb that will be transmitted, the control information in it needs
7113  *	to be filled in
7114  * @reported_rate: The rate control algorithm can fill this in to indicate
7115  *	which rate should be reported to userspace as the current rate and
7116  *	used for rate calculations in the mesh network.
7117  * @rts: whether RTS will be used for this frame because it is longer than the
7118  *	RTS threshold
7119  * @short_preamble: whether mac80211 will request short-preamble transmission
7120  *	if the selected rate supports it
7121  * @rate_idx_mask: user-requested (legacy) rate mask
7122  * @rate_idx_mcs_mask: user-requested MCS rate mask (NULL if not in use)
7123  * @bss: whether this frame is sent out in AP or IBSS mode
7124  */
7125 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control {
7126 	struct ieee80211_hw *hw;
7127 	struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband;
7128 	struct ieee80211_bss_conf *bss_conf;
7129 	struct sk_buff *skb;
7130 	struct ieee80211_tx_rate reported_rate;
7131 	bool rts, short_preamble;
7132 	u32 rate_idx_mask;
7133 	u8 *rate_idx_mcs_mask;
7134 	bool bss;
7135 };
7136 
7137 /**
7138  * enum rate_control_capabilities - rate control capabilities
7139  */
7140 enum rate_control_capabilities {
7141 	/**
7142 	 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW:
7143 	 * Support for extended NSS BW support (dot11VHTExtendedNSSCapable)
7144 	 * Note that this is only looked at if the minimum number of chains
7145 	 * that the AP uses is < the number of TX chains the hardware has,
7146 	 * otherwise the NSS difference doesn't bother us.
7147 	 */
7148 	RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW = BIT(0),
7149 	/**
7150 	 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER:
7151 	 * mac80211 should start A-MPDU sessions on tx
7152 	 */
7153 	RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER = BIT(1),
7154 };
7155 
7156 struct rate_control_ops {
7157 	unsigned long capa;
7158 	const char *name;
7159 	void *(*alloc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
7160 	void (*add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, void *priv,
7161 			    struct dentry *debugfsdir);
7162 	void (*free)(void *priv);
7163 
7164 	void *(*alloc_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, gfp_t gfp);
7165 	void (*rate_init)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7166 			  struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
7167 			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta);
7168 	void (*rate_update)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7169 			    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
7170 			    struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
7171 			    u32 changed);
7172 	void (*free_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
7173 			 void *priv_sta);
7174 
7175 	void (*tx_status_ext)(void *priv,
7176 			      struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7177 			      void *priv_sta, struct ieee80211_tx_status *st);
7178 	void (*tx_status)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7179 			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
7180 			  struct sk_buff *skb);
7181 	void (*get_rate)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
7182 			 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control *txrc);
7183 
7184 	void (*add_sta_debugfs)(void *priv, void *priv_sta,
7185 				struct dentry *dir);
7186 
7187 	u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(void *priv_sta);
7188 };
7189 
7190 static inline int rate_supported(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
7191 				 enum nl80211_band band,
7192 				 int index)
7193 {
7194 	return (sta == NULL || sta->deflink.supp_rates[band] & BIT(index));
7195 }
7196 
7197 static inline s8
7198 rate_lowest_index(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7199 		  struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
7200 {
7201 	int i;
7202 
7203 	for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
7204 		if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
7205 			return i;
7206 
7207 	/* warn when we cannot find a rate. */
7208 	WARN_ON_ONCE(1);
7209 
7210 	/* and return 0 (the lowest index) */
7211 	return 0;
7212 }
7213 
7214 static inline
7215 bool rate_usable_index_exists(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7216 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
7217 {
7218 	unsigned int i;
7219 
7220 	for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
7221 		if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
7222 			return true;
7223 	return false;
7224 }
7225 
7226 /**
7227  * rate_control_set_rates - pass the sta rate selection to mac80211/driver
7228  *
7229  * When not doing a rate control probe to test rates, rate control should pass
7230  * its rate selection to mac80211. If the driver supports receiving a station
7231  * rate table, it will use it to ensure that frames are always sent based on
7232  * the most recent rate control module decision.
7233  *
7234  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7235  * @pubsta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer to the target destination.
7236  * @rates: new tx rate set to be used for this station.
7237  *
7238  * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise.
7239  */
7240 int rate_control_set_rates(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7241 			   struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
7242 			   struct ieee80211_sta_rates *rates);
7243 
7244 int ieee80211_rate_control_register(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
7245 void ieee80211_rate_control_unregister(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
7246 
7247 static inline bool
7248 conf_is_ht20(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7249 {
7250 	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20;
7251 }
7252 
7253 static inline bool
7254 conf_is_ht40_minus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7255 {
7256 	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
7257 	       conf->chandef.center_freq1 < conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
7258 }
7259 
7260 static inline bool
7261 conf_is_ht40_plus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7262 {
7263 	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
7264 	       conf->chandef.center_freq1 > conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
7265 }
7266 
7267 static inline bool
7268 conf_is_ht40(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7269 {
7270 	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40;
7271 }
7272 
7273 static inline bool
7274 conf_is_ht(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7275 {
7276 	return (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5) &&
7277 		(conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10) &&
7278 		(conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT);
7279 }
7280 
7281 static inline enum nl80211_iftype
7282 ieee80211_iftype_p2p(enum nl80211_iftype type, bool p2p)
7283 {
7284 	if (p2p) {
7285 		switch (type) {
7286 		case NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION:
7287 			return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT;
7288 		case NL80211_IFTYPE_AP:
7289 			return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO;
7290 		default:
7291 			break;
7292 		}
7293 	}
7294 	return type;
7295 }
7296 
7297 static inline enum nl80211_iftype
7298 ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
7299 {
7300 	return ieee80211_iftype_p2p(vif->type, vif->p2p);
7301 }
7302 
7303 /**
7304  * ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif - return HE capabilities for sband/vif
7305  * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
7306  * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
7307  *
7308  * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap, or %NULL is none found
7309  */
7310 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap *
7311 ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7312 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
7313 {
7314 	return ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
7315 }
7316 
7317 /**
7318  * ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif - return HE 6 GHz capabilities
7319  * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on
7320  * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
7321  *
7322  * Return: the 6GHz capabilities
7323  */
7324 static inline __le16
7325 ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7326 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
7327 {
7328 	return ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
7329 }
7330 
7331 /**
7332  * ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif - return EHT capabilities for sband/vif
7333  * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
7334  * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
7335  *
7336  * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap, or %NULL is none found
7337  */
7338 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap *
7339 ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7340 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
7341 {
7342 	return ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
7343 }
7344 
7345 /**
7346  * ieee80211_get_uhr_iftype_cap_vif - return UHR capabilities for sband/vif
7347  * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
7348  * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
7349  *
7350  * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_uhr_cap, or %NULL is none found
7351  */
7352 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_uhr_cap *
7353 ieee80211_get_uhr_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7354 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
7355 {
7356 	return ieee80211_get_uhr_iftype_cap(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
7357 }
7358 
7359 /**
7360  * ieee80211_update_mu_groups - set the VHT MU-MIMO groud data
7361  *
7362  * @vif: the specified virtual interface
7363  * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, otherwise 0
7364  * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
7365  * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
7366  *
7367  * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid and the position and
7368  * membership data is of the correct size and are in the same byte order as the
7369  * matching GroupId management frame.
7370  * Calls to this function need to be serialized with RX path.
7371  */
7372 void ieee80211_update_mu_groups(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id,
7373 				const u8 *membership, const u8 *position);
7374 
7375 void ieee80211_enable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7376 				   int rssi_min_thold,
7377 				   int rssi_max_thold);
7378 
7379 void ieee80211_disable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7380 
7381 /**
7382  * ieee80211_ave_rssi - report the average RSSI for the specified interface
7383  *
7384  * @vif: the specified virtual interface
7385  * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, or -1 for non-MLO
7386  *
7387  * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid.
7388  *
7389  * Return: The average RSSI value for the requested interface, or 0 if not
7390  * applicable.
7391  */
7392 int ieee80211_ave_rssi(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int link_id);
7393 
7394 /**
7395  * ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report WoWLAN wakeup
7396  * @vif: virtual interface
7397  * @wakeup: wakeup reason(s)
7398  * @gfp: allocation flags
7399  *
7400  * See cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup().
7401  */
7402 void ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7403 				    struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup,
7404 				    gfp_t gfp);
7405 
7406 /**
7407  * ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb - prepare an 802.11 skb for transmission
7408  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7409  * @vif: virtual interface
7410  * @skb: frame to be sent from within the driver
7411  * @band: the band to transmit on
7412  * @sta: optional pointer to get the station to send the frame to
7413  *
7414  * Return: %true if the skb was prepared, %false otherwise.
7415  * On failure, the skb is freed by this function; callers must not
7416  * free it again.
7417  *
7418  * Note: must be called under RCU lock
7419  */
7420 bool ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7421 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct sk_buff *skb,
7422 			      int band, struct ieee80211_sta **sta);
7423 
7424 /**
7425  * ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap - Sanity-check and parse the radiotap header
7426  *				 of injected frames.
7427  *
7428  * To accurately parse and take into account rate and retransmission fields,
7429  * you must initialize the chandef field in the ieee80211_tx_info structure
7430  * of the skb before calling this function.
7431  *
7432  * @skb: packet injected by userspace
7433  * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
7434  *
7435  * Return: %true if the radiotap header was parsed, %false otherwise
7436  */
7437 bool ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap(struct sk_buff *skb,
7438 				 struct net_device *dev);
7439 
7440 /**
7441  * struct ieee80211_noa_data - holds temporary data for tracking P2P NoA state
7442  *
7443  * @next_tsf: TSF timestamp of the next absent state change
7444  * @has_next_tsf: next absent state change event pending
7445  *
7446  * @absent: descriptor bitmask, set if GO is currently absent
7447  *
7448  * private:
7449  *
7450  * @count: count fields from the NoA descriptors
7451  * @desc: adjusted data from the NoA
7452  */
7453 struct ieee80211_noa_data {
7454 	u32 next_tsf;
7455 	bool has_next_tsf;
7456 
7457 	u8 absent;
7458 
7459 	u8 count[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
7460 	struct {
7461 		u32 start;
7462 		u32 duration;
7463 		u32 interval;
7464 	} desc[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
7465 };
7466 
7467 /**
7468  * ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa - initialize NoA tracking data from P2P IE
7469  *
7470  * @attr: P2P NoA IE
7471  * @data: NoA tracking data
7472  * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
7473  *
7474  * Return: number of successfully parsed descriptors
7475  */
7476 int ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa(const struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr *attr,
7477 			    struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
7478 
7479 /**
7480  * ieee80211_update_p2p_noa - get next pending P2P GO absent state change
7481  *
7482  * @data: NoA tracking data
7483  * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
7484  */
7485 void ieee80211_update_p2p_noa(struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
7486 
7487 /**
7488  * ieee80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform a TDLS operation
7489  * @vif: virtual interface
7490  * @peer: the peer's destination address
7491  * @oper: the requested TDLS operation
7492  * @reason_code: reason code for the operation, valid for TDLS teardown
7493  * @gfp: allocation flags
7494  *
7495  * See cfg80211_tdls_oper_request().
7496  */
7497 void ieee80211_tdls_oper_request(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *peer,
7498 				 enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper,
7499 				 u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp);
7500 
7501 /**
7502  * ieee80211_reserve_tid - request to reserve a specific TID
7503  *
7504  * There is sometimes a need (such as in TDLS) for blocking the driver from
7505  * using a specific TID so that the FW can use it for certain operations such
7506  * as sending PTI requests. To make sure that the driver doesn't use that TID,
7507  * this function must be called as it flushes out packets on this TID and marks
7508  * it as blocked, so that any transmit for the station on this TID will be
7509  * redirected to the alternative TID in the same AC.
7510  *
7511  * Note that this function blocks and may call back into the driver, so it
7512  * should be called without driver locks held. Also note this function should
7513  * only be called from the driver's @sta_state callback.
7514  *
7515  * @sta: the station to reserve the TID for
7516  * @tid: the TID to reserve
7517  *
7518  * Returns: 0 on success, else on failure
7519  */
7520 int ieee80211_reserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
7521 
7522 /**
7523  * ieee80211_unreserve_tid - request to unreserve a specific TID
7524  *
7525  * Once there is no longer any need for reserving a certain TID, this function
7526  * should be called, and no longer will packets have their TID modified for
7527  * preventing use of this TID in the driver.
7528  *
7529  * Note that this function blocks and acquires a lock, so it should be called
7530  * without driver locks held. Also note this function should only be called
7531  * from the driver's @sta_state callback.
7532  *
7533  * @sta: the station
7534  * @tid: the TID to unreserve
7535  */
7536 void ieee80211_unreserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
7537 
7538 /**
7539  * ieee80211_tx_dequeue - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
7540  *
7541  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7542  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
7543  *	ieee80211_next_txq()
7544  *
7545  * Return: the skb if successful, %NULL if no frame was available.
7546  *
7547  * Note that this must be called in an rcu_read_lock() critical section,
7548  * which can only be released after the SKB was handled. Some pointers in
7549  * skb->cb, e.g. the key pointer, are protected by RCU and thus the
7550  * critical section must persist not just for the duration of this call
7551  * but for the duration of the frame handling.
7552  * However, also note that while in the wake_tx_queue() method,
7553  * rcu_read_lock() is already held.
7554  *
7555  * softirqs must also be disabled when this function is called.
7556  * In process context, use ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni() instead.
7557  */
7558 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7559 				     struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7560 
7561 /**
7562  * ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
7563  * (in process context)
7564  *
7565  * Like ieee80211_tx_dequeue() but can be called in process context
7566  * (internally disables bottom halves).
7567  *
7568  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7569  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
7570  *	ieee80211_next_txq()
7571  *
7572  * Return: the skb if successful, %NULL if no frame was available.
7573  */
7574 static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7575 						      struct ieee80211_txq *txq)
7576 {
7577 	struct sk_buff *skb;
7578 
7579 	local_bh_disable();
7580 	skb = ieee80211_tx_dequeue(hw, txq);
7581 	local_bh_enable();
7582 
7583 	return skb;
7584 }
7585 
7586 /**
7587  * ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue - mac80211 handler for wake_tx_queue callback
7588  *
7589  * @hw: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback().
7590  * @txq: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback().
7591  *
7592  * Drivers can use this function for the mandatory mac80211 wake_tx_queue
7593  * callback in struct ieee80211_ops. They should not call this function.
7594  */
7595 void ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7596 				    struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7597 
7598 /**
7599  * ieee80211_next_txq - get next tx queue to pull packets from
7600  *
7601  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7602  * @ac: AC number to return packets from.
7603  *
7604  * Return: the next txq if successful, %NULL if no queue is eligible. If a txq
7605  * is returned, it should be returned with ieee80211_return_txq() after the
7606  * driver has finished scheduling it.
7607  */
7608 struct ieee80211_txq *ieee80211_next_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);
7609 
7610 /**
7611  * ieee80211_txq_schedule_start - start new scheduling round for TXQs
7612  *
7613  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7614  * @ac: AC number to acquire locks for
7615  *
7616  * Should be called before ieee80211_next_txq() or ieee80211_return_txq().
7617  * The driver must not call multiple TXQ scheduling rounds concurrently.
7618  */
7619 void ieee80211_txq_schedule_start(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);
7620 
7621 /* (deprecated) */
7622 static inline void ieee80211_txq_schedule_end(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac)
7623 {
7624 }
7625 
7626 void __ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7627 			      struct ieee80211_txq *txq, bool force);
7628 
7629 /**
7630  * ieee80211_schedule_txq - schedule a TXQ for transmission
7631  *
7632  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7633  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7634  *
7635  * Schedules a TXQ for transmission if it is not already scheduled,
7636  * even if mac80211 does not have any packets buffered.
7637  *
7638  * The driver may call this function if it has buffered packets for
7639  * this TXQ internally.
7640  */
7641 static inline void
7642 ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq)
7643 {
7644 	__ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, true);
7645 }
7646 
7647 /**
7648  * ieee80211_return_txq - return a TXQ previously acquired by ieee80211_next_txq()
7649  *
7650  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7651  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7652  * @force: schedule txq even if mac80211 does not have any buffered packets.
7653  *
7654  * The driver may set force=true if it has buffered packets for this TXQ
7655  * internally.
7656  */
7657 static inline void
7658 ieee80211_return_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
7659 		     bool force)
7660 {
7661 	__ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, force);
7662 }
7663 
7664 /**
7665  * ieee80211_txq_may_transmit - check whether TXQ is allowed to transmit
7666  *
7667  * This function is used to check whether given txq is allowed to transmit by
7668  * the airtime scheduler, and can be used by drivers to access the airtime
7669  * fairness accounting without using the scheduling order enforced by
7670  * next_txq().
7671  *
7672  * Returns %true if the airtime scheduler thinks the TXQ should be allowed to
7673  * transmit, and %false if it should be throttled. This function can also have
7674  * the side effect of rotating the TXQ in the scheduler rotation, which will
7675  * eventually bring the deficit to positive and allow the station to transmit
7676  * again.
7677  *
7678  * The API ieee80211_txq_may_transmit() also ensures that TXQ list will be
7679  * aligned against driver's own round-robin scheduler list. i.e it rotates
7680  * the TXQ list till it makes the requested node becomes the first entry
7681  * in TXQ list. Thus both the TXQ list and driver's list are in sync. If this
7682  * function returns %true, the driver is expected to schedule packets
7683  * for transmission, and then return the TXQ through ieee80211_return_txq().
7684  *
7685  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7686  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7687  *
7688  * Return: %true if transmission is allowed, %false otherwise
7689  */
7690 bool ieee80211_txq_may_transmit(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7691 				struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7692 
7693 /**
7694  * ieee80211_txq_get_depth - get pending frame/byte count of given txq
7695  *
7696  * The values are not guaranteed to be coherent with regard to each other, i.e.
7697  * txq state can change half-way of this function and the caller may end up
7698  * with "new" frame_cnt and "old" byte_cnt or vice-versa.
7699  *
7700  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7701  * @frame_cnt: pointer to store frame count
7702  * @byte_cnt: pointer to store byte count
7703  */
7704 void ieee80211_txq_get_depth(struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
7705 			     unsigned long *frame_cnt,
7706 			     unsigned long *byte_cnt);
7707 
7708 /**
7709  * ieee80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination.
7710  *
7711  * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function termination.
7712  * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
7713  *
7714  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7715  * @inst_id: the local instance id
7716  * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*)
7717  * @gfp: allocation flags
7718  */
7719 void ieee80211_nan_func_terminated(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7720 				   u8 inst_id,
7721 				   enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason,
7722 				   gfp_t gfp);
7723 
7724 /**
7725  * ieee80211_nan_func_match - notify about NAN function match event.
7726  *
7727  * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function match. The
7728  * cookie inside the match struct will be assigned by mac80211.
7729  * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
7730  *
7731  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7732  * @match: match event information
7733  * @gfp: allocation flags
7734  */
7735 void ieee80211_nan_func_match(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7736 			      struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match,
7737 			      gfp_t gfp);
7738 
7739 /**
7740  * ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for RX.
7741  *
7742  * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the
7743  * rate information in the RX status struct and the frame length.
7744  *
7745  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7746  * @status: &struct ieee80211_rx_status containing the transmission rate
7747  *          information.
7748  * @len: frame length in bytes
7749  *
7750  * Return: the airtime estimate
7751  */
7752 u32 ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7753 			      struct ieee80211_rx_status *status,
7754 			      int len);
7755 
7756 /**
7757  * ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for TX.
7758  *
7759  * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the
7760  * rate information in the TX info struct and the frame length.
7761  *
7762  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7763  * @info: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
7764  * @len: frame length in bytes
7765  *
7766  * Return: the airtime estimate
7767  */
7768 u32 ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7769 			      struct ieee80211_tx_info *info,
7770 			      int len);
7771 /**
7772  * ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl - Get FILS discovery template.
7773  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
7774  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7775  * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO.
7776  *
7777  * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
7778  *
7779  * Return: FILS discovery template. %NULL on error.
7780  */
7781 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7782 						  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7783 						  unsigned int link_id);
7784 
7785 /**
7786  * ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl - Get unsolicited broadcast
7787  *	probe response template.
7788  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
7789  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7790  * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO.
7791  *
7792  * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
7793  *
7794  * Return: Unsolicited broadcast probe response template. %NULL on error.
7795  */
7796 struct sk_buff *
7797 ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7798 					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7799 					  unsigned int link_id);
7800 
7801 /**
7802  * ieee80211_obss_color_collision_notify - notify userland about a BSS color
7803  * collision.
7804  * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
7805  *
7806  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7807  * @color_bitmap: a 64 bit bitmap representing the colors that the local BSS is
7808  *	aware of.
7809  */
7810 void
7811 ieee80211_obss_color_collision_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7812 				      u64 color_bitmap, u8 link_id);
7813 
7814 /**
7815  * ieee80211_is_tx_data - check if frame is a data frame
7816  *
7817  * The function is used to check if a frame is a data frame. Frames with
7818  * hardware encapsulation enabled are data frames.
7819  *
7820  * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
7821  *
7822  * Return: %true if @skb is a data frame, %false otherwise
7823  */
7824 static inline bool ieee80211_is_tx_data(struct sk_buff *skb)
7825 {
7826 	struct ieee80211_tx_info *info = IEEE80211_SKB_CB(skb);
7827 	struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (void *) skb->data;
7828 
7829 	return info->flags & IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP ||
7830 	       ieee80211_is_data(hdr->frame_control);
7831 }
7832 
7833 /**
7834  * ieee80211_set_active_links - set active links in client mode
7835  * @vif: interface to set active links on
7836  * @active_links: the new active links bitmap
7837  *
7838  * Context: Must be called with wiphy mutex held; may sleep; calls
7839  *	back into the driver.
7840  *
7841  * This changes the active links on an interface. The interface
7842  * must be in client mode (in AP mode, all links are always active),
7843  * and @active_links must be a subset of the vif's valid_links.
7844  *
7845  * If a link is switched off and another is switched on at the same
7846  * time (e.g. active_links going from 0x1 to 0x10) then you will get
7847  * a sequence of calls like
7848  *
7849  *  - change_vif_links(0x11)
7850  *  - unassign_vif_chanctx(link_id=0)
7851  *  - assign_vif_chanctx(link_id=4)
7852  *  - change_sta_links(0x11) for each affected STA (the AP)
7853  *    (TDLS connections on now inactive links should be torn down)
7854  *  - remove group keys on the old link (link_id 0)
7855  *  - add new group keys (GTK/IGTK/BIGTK) on the new link (link_id 4)
7856  *  - change_sta_links(0x10) for each affected STA (the AP)
7857  *  - change_vif_links(0x10)
7858  *
7859  * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise.
7860  */
7861 int ieee80211_set_active_links(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 active_links);
7862 
7863 /**
7864  * ieee80211_set_active_links_async - asynchronously set active links
7865  * @vif: interface to set active links on
7866  * @active_links: the new active links bitmap
7867  *
7868  * See ieee80211_set_active_links() for more information, the only
7869  * difference here is that the link change is triggered async and
7870  * can be called in any context, but the link switch will only be
7871  * completed after it returns.
7872  */
7873 void ieee80211_set_active_links_async(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7874 				      u16 active_links);
7875 
7876 /**
7877  * ieee80211_send_teardown_neg_ttlm - tear down a negotiated TTLM request
7878  * @vif: the interface on which the tear down request should be sent.
7879  *
7880  * This function can be used to tear down a previously accepted negotiated
7881  * TTLM request.
7882  */
7883 void ieee80211_send_teardown_neg_ttlm(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7884 
7885 /**
7886  * ieee80211_chan_width_to_rx_bw - convert channel width to STA RX bandwidth
7887  * @width: the channel width value to convert
7888  * Return: the STA RX bandwidth value for the channel width
7889  */
7890 static inline enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth
7891 ieee80211_chan_width_to_rx_bw(enum nl80211_chan_width width)
7892 {
7893 	switch (width) {
7894 	default:
7895 		WARN_ON_ONCE(1);
7896 		fallthrough;
7897 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT:
7898 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20:
7899 		return IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20;
7900 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40:
7901 		return IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40;
7902 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80:
7903 		return IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80;
7904 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_160:
7905 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80P80:
7906 		return IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160;
7907 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_320:
7908 		return IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320;
7909 	}
7910 }
7911 
7912 /**
7913  * ieee80211_prepare_rx_omi_bw - prepare for sending BW RX OMI
7914  * @link_sta: the link STA the OMI is going to be sent to
7915  * @bw: the bandwidth requested
7916  *
7917  * When the driver decides to do RX OMI to change bandwidth with a STA
7918  * it calls this function to prepare, then sends the OMI, and finally
7919  * calls ieee80211_finalize_rx_omi_bw().
7920  *
7921  * Note that the (link) STA rate control is updated accordingly as well,
7922  * but the chanctx might not be updated if there are other users.
7923  * If the intention is to reduce the listen bandwidth, the driver must
7924  * ensure there are no TDLS stations nor other uses of the chanctx.
7925  *
7926  * Also note that in order to sequence correctly, narrowing bandwidth
7927  * will only happen in ieee80211_finalize_rx_omi_bw(), whereas widening
7928  * again (e.g. going back to normal) will happen here.
7929  *
7930  * Note that we treat this symmetrically, so if the driver calls this
7931  * and tells the peer to only send with a lower bandwidth, we assume
7932  * that the driver also wants to only send at that lower bandwidth, to
7933  * allow narrowing of the chanctx request for this station/interface.
7934  *
7935  * Finally, the driver must ensure that if the function returned %true,
7936  * ieee80211_finalize_rx_omi_bw() is also called, even for example in
7937  * case of HW restart.
7938  *
7939  * Context: Must be called with wiphy mutex held, and will call back
7940  *	    into the driver, so ensure no driver locks are held.
7941  *
7942  * Return: %true if changes are going to be made, %false otherwise
7943  */
7944 bool ieee80211_prepare_rx_omi_bw(struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta,
7945 				 enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth bw);
7946 
7947 /**
7948  * ieee80211_finalize_rx_omi_bw - finalize BW RX OMI update
7949  * @link_sta: the link STA the OMI was sent to
7950  *
7951  * See ieee80211_client_prepare_rx_omi_bw(). Context is the same here
7952  * as well.
7953  */
7954 void ieee80211_finalize_rx_omi_bw(struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta);
7955 
7956 /* for older drivers - let's not document these ... */
7957 int ieee80211_emulate_add_chanctx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7958 				  struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
7959 void ieee80211_emulate_remove_chanctx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7960 				      struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
7961 void ieee80211_emulate_change_chanctx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7962 				      struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx,
7963 				      u32 changed);
7964 int ieee80211_emulate_switch_vif_chanctx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7965 					 struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch *vifs,
7966 					 int n_vifs,
7967 					 enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode mode);
7968 
7969 /**
7970  * ieee80211_vif_nan_started - Return whether a NAN vif is started
7971  * @vif: the vif
7972  * Return: %true iff the vif is a NAN interface and NAN is started
7973  */
7974 bool ieee80211_vif_nan_started(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7975 
7976 /**
7977  * ieee80211_encrypt_tx_skb - Encrypt the transmit skb
7978  * @skb: the skb
7979  * Return: 0 if success and non-zero on error
7980  */
7981 int ieee80211_encrypt_tx_skb(struct sk_buff *skb);
7982 #endif /* MAC80211_H */
7983